US20210329486A1 - System and method for reducing data packet processing false alarms - Google Patents
System and method for reducing data packet processing false alarms Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20210329486A1 US20210329486A1 US17/230,783 US202117230783A US2021329486A1 US 20210329486 A1 US20210329486 A1 US 20210329486A1 US 202117230783 A US202117230783 A US 202117230783A US 2021329486 A1 US2021329486 A1 US 2021329486A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- wireless communication
- communication device
- packet
- sta
- address
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Granted
Links
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 title claims description 64
- 238000012545 processing Methods 0.000 title description 38
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 claims description 217
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 claims description 202
- 230000035945 sensitivity Effects 0.000 claims description 87
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 claims description 33
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 claims description 25
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 34
- 238000010586 diagram Methods 0.000 description 26
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 7
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000001360 synchronised effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 239000000872 buffer Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000007726 management method Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000013468 resource allocation Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000001413 cellular effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 3
- 206010000210 abortion Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 230000009471 action Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003190 augmentative effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- VYLDEYYOISNGST-UHFFFAOYSA-N bissulfosuccinimidyl suberate Chemical compound O=C1C(S(=O)(=O)O)CC(=O)N1OC(=O)CCCCCCC(=O)ON1C(=O)C(S(O)(=O)=O)CC1=O VYLDEYYOISNGST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000012790 confirmation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001934 delay Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000010187 selection method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000002776 aggregation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004220 aggregation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000004458 analytical method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000003491 array Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003139 buffering effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008676 import Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000006872 improvement Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002452 interceptive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000007774 longterm Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000012544 monitoring process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006855 networking Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000013307 optical fiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005457 optimization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000004984 smart glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000006467 substitution reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000012549 training Methods 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L69/00—Network arrangements, protocols or services independent of the application payload and not provided for in the other groups of this subclass
- H04L69/22—Parsing or analysis of headers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W40/00—Communication routing or communication path finding
- H04W40/02—Communication route or path selection, e.g. power-based or shortest path routing
- H04W40/12—Communication route or path selection, e.g. power-based or shortest path routing based on transmission quality or channel quality
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L45/00—Routing or path finding of packets in data switching networks
- H04L45/74—Address processing for routing
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04B—TRANSMISSION
- H04B17/00—Monitoring; Testing
- H04B17/30—Monitoring; Testing of propagation channels
- H04B17/309—Measuring or estimating channel quality parameters
- H04B17/318—Received signal strength
- H04B17/327—Received signal code power [RSCP]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L45/00—Routing or path finding of packets in data switching networks
- H04L45/24—Multipath
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L67/00—Network arrangements or protocols for supporting network services or applications
- H04L67/50—Network services
- H04L67/56—Provisioning of proxy services
- H04L67/568—Storing data temporarily at an intermediate stage, e.g. caching
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L67/00—Network arrangements or protocols for supporting network services or applications
- H04L67/50—Network services
- H04L67/60—Scheduling or organising the servicing of application requests, e.g. requests for application data transmissions using the analysis and optimisation of the required network resources
- H04L67/63—Routing a service request depending on the request content or context
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L69/00—Network arrangements, protocols or services independent of the application payload and not provided for in the other groups of this subclass
- H04L69/40—Network arrangements, protocols or services independent of the application payload and not provided for in the other groups of this subclass for recovering from a failure of a protocol instance or entity, e.g. service redundancy protocols, protocol state redundancy or protocol service redirection
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W12/00—Security arrangements; Authentication; Protecting privacy or anonymity
- H04W12/06—Authentication
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/02—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control
- H04W28/0231—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control based on communication conditions
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/02—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control
- H04W28/0252—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control per individual bearer or channel
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/02—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control
- H04W28/06—Optimizing the usage of the radio link, e.g. header compression, information sizing, discarding information
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W4/00—Services specially adapted for wireless communication networks; Facilities therefor
- H04W4/80—Services using short range communication, e.g. near-field communication [NFC], radio-frequency identification [RFID] or low energy communication
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W40/00—Communication routing or communication path finding
- H04W40/02—Communication route or path selection, e.g. power-based or shortest path routing
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W40/00—Communication routing or communication path finding
- H04W40/24—Connectivity information management, e.g. connectivity discovery or connectivity update
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W84/00—Network topologies
- H04W84/02—Hierarchically pre-organised networks, e.g. paging networks, cellular networks, WLAN [Wireless Local Area Network] or WLL [Wireless Local Loop]
- H04W84/10—Small scale networks; Flat hierarchical networks
- H04W84/12—WLAN [Wireless Local Area Networks]
Definitions
- Embodiments of this disclosure relate to wireless communication systems, such as multiple-input multiple output wireless communication systems.
- the wireless communication device further comprises a processor in communication with the antenna, where the computer-executable instructions, when executed by the processor, cause the wireless communication device to: decode a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a second wireless communication device; determine that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet does not match an address of the wireless communication device; and begin to search for a new packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device or a third wireless communication device before transmission of the first packet is complete.
- the wireless communication device of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to transmit to the second wireless communication device information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm; where the information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm comprises a received power level of the first packet; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: process a minimum receive sensitivity level received from the second wireless communication device, and ignore any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to determine a minimum receive sensitivity level based on at least one of a received power level of the first packet or received power levels of one or more other packets detected by the wireless communication device that had a destination address that did not match the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: transmit a second packet to the second wireless communication device, and determine that
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides a computer-implemented method comprising: decoding a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a second wireless communication device; determining that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet does not match an address of the wireless communication device; and begin searching for a new packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device or a third wireless communication device before transmission of the first packet is complete.
- the computer-implemented method of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-implemented method further comprises: transmitting to the second wireless communication device information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm, receiving a minimum receive sensitivity level from the second wireless communication device, and ignoring any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level.
- the wireless computing device further comprises a processor in communication with the antenna, where the computer-executable instructions, when executed by the processor, cause the wireless computing device to: authenticate with one or more access points; decode a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a first access point in the one or more access points; determine that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address of the wireless computing device; and process the first packet in response to the determination that the destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the wireless computing device, irrespective of a source address included in the first portion of the first packet.
- the wireless computing device of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: decode a first portion of a second packet transmitted by the first access point, determine that a destination address included in the first portion of the second packet does not match an address of the wireless computing device, and begin to search for a new packet transmitted by any access point in the one or more access points before transmission of the second packet is complete; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to transmit to the first access point information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm; where the information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm comprises a received power level of the second packet; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: process a minimum receive sensitivity level received from the first access point, and ignore any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to determine
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides computer-implemented method comprising: authenticating, by a wireless computing device, with one or more access points; decoding a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a first access point in the one or more access points; determining that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address of the wireless computing device; and processing the first packet in response to the determination that the destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the wireless computing device, irrespective of a source address included in the first portion of the first packet.
- the computer-implemented method of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-implemented method further comprises: decoding a first portion of a second packet transmitted by the first access point, determining that a destination address included in the first portion of the second packet does not match an address of the wireless computing device, and begin searching for a new packet transmitted by any access point in the one or more access points before transmission of the second packet is complete; where the computer-implemented method further comprises: transmitting to the first access point information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm, receiving a minimum receive sensitivity level from the first access point, and ignoring any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level; where the computer-implemented method further comprises determining a minimum receive sensitivity level based on at least one of a received power level of the second packet or received power levels of one or more other packets detected by the wireless communication device that had a destination address that did not match the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-implemented method
- the access point further comprises a processor in communication with the antenna, where the computer-executable instructions, when executed by the processor, cause the access point to: authenticate a wireless communication device; decode a first portion of a first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device; determine that an address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address associated with the wireless communication device; and process the first packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device, irrespective of whether the first packet includes an address of the access point.
- the access point of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to process the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the wireless communication device is authenticated and the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device; where the address included in the first portion of the first packet is a source address in a header of the first packet; where the first portion of the first packet includes a wildcard address associated with the access point; where the address associated with the wireless communication device is an address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to process the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet is a source address that matches the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to process the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the address included in the first
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides computer-implemented method comprising: authenticating, by an access point, a wireless communication device; decoding a first portion of a first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device; determining that an address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address associated with the wireless communication device; and processing the first packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device, irrespective of whether the first packet includes an address of the access point.
- processing the first packet further comprises processing the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the wireless communication device is authenticated and the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides a wireless communication system comprising a plurality of access points, where the access point transmission timelines are synchronized, and where each access point transmission start time aligns to a raster interval.
- the wireless communication system of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where access point transmission start times are offset to a plurality of other access point start times; where access point offsets are assigned according to a re-use pattern; where access point transmission start times include at least one start time that is not an assigned offset; where the non-offset aligned start times are controlled probabilistically; where the offset re-use assignment is dynamically reconfigured in response to changes in the active access points; and where access point transmission times are adjusted to ensure that station acknowledgement or negative acknowledgement message lags the preamble, and that the station acknowledgement or negative acknowledgement message leads the raster start times.
- FIG. 1A is a diagram of a multipoint environment in which multiple stations and access points can communicate with each other according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 1B is a schematic diagram illustrating a wireless network that includes the baseband unit according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 2 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 3 is another block diagram of the multipoint environment of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 4 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA using false alarm information according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 5 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA using missed detect information according to an embodiment.
- FIGS. 6A-6B are block diagrams of the multipoint environment of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to pre-cache data packets according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 7 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine illustratively implemented by a STA and/or an AP, according to one embodiment.
- FIG. 8 is a flow diagram depicting a minimum Rx sensitivity selection routine illustratively implemented by an AP, an AP controller, and/or a STA according to one embodiment.
- FIG. 9 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine illustratively implemented by a STA, according to one embodiment.
- FIG. 10 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine illustratively implemented by an AP, according to one embodiment.
- FIG. 11 is a block diagram illustrating an example baseband unit and remote radio unit according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example STA according to an embodiment.
- FIG. 13 illustrates an example timeline for packet transmissions from an AP to a STA, depicting reasons why a data packet transmission miss may occur.
- FIG. 14 illustrates a synchronized system in which AP packet transmission times are synchronized to a raster.
- FIG. 15 illustrates a timeline of ACK and/or NAK transmission that may reduce the likelihood that ACK and/or NAK transmissions result in missed AP preambles.
- a station typically decodes a packet and analyzes a destination address and source address included in the header of the packet to determine whether the packet is intended for the STA.
- Access points perform a similar operation. Decoding a packet and analyzing the destination address and the source address, however, can increase a time that it takes a STA or AP to process a received packet.
- a STA or AP may detect that transmission of a packet is occurring and attempting to decode the packet.
- the STA or AP may eventually determine that the packet is not meant for the STA or AP (e.g., based on an analysis of the destination address and source address in the header of the packet).
- the STA or AP typically remains locked onto the packet until transmission of the packet is complete, even after determining that the packet is not meant for the STA or AP (where the determination generally occurs before transmission of the packet is complete).
- a typical STA or AP detects the transmission of a first packet, the STA or AP does not start searching for a new packet until transmission of the first packet is complete whether or not the first packet is actually intended for the STA or AP. If a packet that is actually intended for the STA or AP is transmitted or begins to be transmitted before transmission of a packet locked onto by and not intended for the STA or AP is complete, then the STA or AP may not receive or process the packet that is actually intended for the STA or AP.
- false alarms can increase the latency of the wireless network in situations in which a STA or AP locks onto a packet not intended for the STA or AP, and can reduce the reliability of the wireless network in situations in which the STA or AP misses a packet intended for the STA or AP because the STA or AP was locked onto another packet not intended for the STA or AP.
- obstructions and/or interference can prevent a STA from receiving a transmission from an AP, and vice-versa.
- a STA or AP may retransmit a packet if an initial transmission fails (e.g., if the AP or STA for which the packet is intended does not receive the packet, as indicated by the failure of the AP or STA to send an acknowledgement message acknowledging receipt of the packet).
- obstructions and/or interference can also reduce the reliability of the wireless network.
- a STA can authenticate simultaneously with multiple APs and decode any data packet that includes in a header a destination address that matches an address of the STA, irrespective of the source address included in the header of the data packet.
- an AP can decode any data packet that includes in a header a destination address that matches an address of the AP or that matches a wildcard address associated with the AP, irrespective of the source address included in the header of the data packet.
- the multipoint environment described herein has no pre-defined AP to which a STA is associated. Rather, the AP transmitting a data packet to a particular STA can change on a packet-by-packet basis. For example, a first AP can transmit a first data packet to a STA at a first time, a second AP can transmit a second data packet to the STA at a second time, a third AP can transmit a third data packet to the STA at a third time, the first AP can transmit a fourth data packet to the STA at a fourth time, and so on.
- a first AP can transmit a first data packet to a STA at a first time
- a second AP can transmit a second data packet to the STA at a second time
- a third AP can transmit a third data packet to the STA at a third time
- the first AP can transmit a fourth data packet to the STA at a fourth time, and so on.
- the AP that transmits a data packet to the STA can change without the STA changing BSSs to which the STA is associated—the STA may remain in the same BSS using the same, single wireless stack while the AP that transmits data packets to the STA changes.
- the multipoint environment can further include an AP controller (also referred to herein as a central controller) that can select the AP to transmit a data packet to a STA.
- the AP controller can route traffic to one or more APs for transmission to one or more STAs based on downlink and/or uplink quality measurements.
- the STAs and APs in the multipoint environment can each be configured to restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP, use a minimum receive (Rx) sensitivity level below which the STA or AP does not attempt to decode the header of a data packet, or both restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP and use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to decode the header of a data packet.
- Rx receive
- a STA or AP can decode the header of a detected data packet to determine whether the destination address included in the header matches an address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP. If the destination address does not produce a match (indicating that the data packet is not intended for the STA or AP), then the STA or AP can start searching for a new data packet without waiting for transmission of the initial data packet to finish.
- the STA or AP can start a physical (PHY) clear channel assessment (CCA) and short training field (STF) detection procedure to detect transmissions of data packets (e.g., to begin detecting the transmission of a preamble, header, and/or data payload of a data packet).
- PHY physical
- STF short training field
- the STA or AP can decode the destination address included in the preamble or header.
- the STA or AP can restart the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to detect the transmission of another packet, even before transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet is complete.
- a STA can provide to an AP information identifying a false alarm when the STA attempts to decode a data packet only to find that the destination address of the data packet does not match the address of the STA.
- the AP can gather information for one or more false alarms identified by the STA, and use this information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA. For example, the AP can determine the mean, median, mode, etc. of the received power level of the data packets that the STA identified as resulting in a false alarm, and the AP can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA to be some level above the mean, median, mode, etc. of the received power level of the data packets that the STA identified as resulting in a false alarm.
- the AP can gather information for one or more missed detects (e.g., data packet transmissions intended for the STA that were not received by the STA) and use this information alone or with the false alarm information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA.
- the AP can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be some level below the mean, median, mode, etc. of the transmission power level of the data packets intended for the STA that were not received by the STA (or the power level at which the data packets should have been received by the STA) minus the estimate of the path loss from the AP to the STA.
- the AP can then provide the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to the STA so that the STA can begin using the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet.
- an AP can use missed detect information obtained from a STA (e.g., information identifying data packets intended for the AP that were not received by the AP) and/or false alarm information determined by the AP (e.g., information associated with data packets decoded by the AP that were not intended for the AP) to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for itself in a similar manner.
- the AP can then use the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet.
- the multipoint environment increases the reliability and reduces the latency of a wireless network. For example, reliability may be increased because an STA or AP is less likely to miss a data packet intended for the STA or AP given that the STA or AP is no longer waiting for transmission of a data packet to finish before searching for a new data packet. Latency of the wireless network may be reduced because a STA or AP may no longer decode all detected data packets. Rather, the STA or AP may only decode those data packets that have a received power level over a minimum Rx sensitivity level, which may cause the STA or AP to decode sooner those data packets actually intended for the STA or AP.
- the AP controller may further increase reliability and reduce latency in the wireless network by implementing retransmission diversity. For example, transmission of a data packet from an AP to a STA or from a STA to an AP may fail due to an obstruction (e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.) and/or interference (e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP or STA) being present. Generally, the data packet may be retransmitted in response to the initial transmission failure.
- an obstruction e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.
- interference e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP or STA
- Retransmitting the data packet from the same STA or AP is likely to result in another transmission failure, however, because retransmissions generally occur soon after the initial transmission (e.g., 1 ms after, 10 ms after, 100 ms after, etc.) and the obstruction and/or interference is still likely to be present given the short timeframe between transmissions.
- the AP controller can trigger a retransmission of the data packet from another STA or AP, such as from a STA or AP that has a different spatial location than the STA or AP that originally transmitted the data packet. Accordingly, the retransmission is less likely to be affected by the obstruction and/or interference, and the recipient STA or AP is then more likely to receive the retransmitted data packet.
- the AP controller can pre-cache a data packet at one or more APs, even before the AP that is originally assigned to transmit the data packet transmits the data packet. For example, there may be a time delay involved in an AP controller transmitting a data packet to an AP so that the AP can transmit the data packet to a STA. Pre-caching the data packet at multiple APs before the data packet is transmitted by any AP (and therefore before a transmission failure occurs) may reduce the time it takes for a second AP to retransmit the data packet if the first transmission of the data packet fails.
- the AP controller can instruct a second AP at which the data packet has already been pre-cached to transmit the data packet.
- the time waiting for the second AP to receive the data packet from the AP controller is therefore eliminated.
- the time from when the AP controller determines that the second AP should retransmit the data packet to when the second AP retransmits the data packet is reduced, thereby reducing the latency involved with retransmitting the data packet.
- the multipoint environment described herein is designed to operate at higher frequencies, such as at millimeter wave (mmW) frequencies, such as between 24 GHz to 300 GHz.
- mmW frequencies can encompass at least some frequency ranges between 2 GHz to 3 GHz, at least some frequency ranges in the Super high frequency (SHF) bands (e.g., 3 GHz to 30 GHz), and/or at least some frequency ranges in the Extremely High Frequency (EHF) bands (e.g., 30 GHz to 300 GHz).
- SHF Super high frequency
- EHF Extremely High Frequency
- the techniques described herein can be applied to networks operating at any suitable range of frequencies.
- the techniques described herein can be used for a variety of use cases, such as media streaming, video chat, virtual reality, augmented reality, etc.
- FIG. 1A is a diagram of a multipoint environment 100 in which multiple STAs 110 A-D and APs 108 A-I can communicate with each other according to an embodiment.
- the multipoint environment 100 includes a plurality of APs 108 A-I, a plurality of STAs 110 A-D, an AP controller 106 , and a baseband unit 140 .
- data packets can be wirelessly transmitted from the baseband unit 140 to the plurality of STAs 110 A-D via one or more of the APs 108 A-I.
- data packets can be transmitted from the plurality of STAs 110 A-D to one or more APs 108 A-I.
- a STA 110 A-D can communicate with multiple APs 108 A-I and an AP 108 A-I can communicate with multiple STAs 110 A-D in a single wireless stack (e.g., a single IEEE 820 . 11 protocol stack).
- a single wireless stack e.g., a single IEEE 820 . 11 protocol stack.
- a STA 110 A-D can authenticate simultaneously with multiple APs 108 A-I (e.g., one or more of the APs 108 A-I can individual or collectively authenticate the STA 110 A-D upon request from the STA 110 A-D) and decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of the STA 110 A-D, irrespective of the source address included in the header or preamble of the data packet (e.g., the STA 110 A-D can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of the STA 110 A-D whether or not the source address is the address of a particular AP 108 A-I).
- an AP 108 A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of the AP 108 A-I or that matches a wildcard address associated with the AP 108 A-I, irrespective of the source address included in the header of the data packet (e.g., the AP 108 A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of the AP 108 A-I or that matches a wildcard address associated with the AP 108 A-I whether or not the source address is the address of a particular STA 110 A-D).
- a wildcard address may be an address associated with multiple APs 108 A-I rather than a unique address associated with just one AP 108 A-I.
- the address associated with multiple APs 108 A-I could be one or more addresses of one or more STAs 110 A-D that has authenticated with some or all of the APs 108 A-I.
- the wildcard address can be one or more addresses of one or more authenticated STAs 110 A-D.
- an AP 108 A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a source address that matches an address of one of a set of STAs 110 A-D, such as an address of a STA 110 A-D that has already authenticated with the AP 108 A-I or another AP 108 A-I that is part of the same wireless protocol stack as the AP 108 A-I, irrespective of whether the destination address in the header or preamble matches an address of the AP 108 A-I (e.g., the AP 108 A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a source address that matches an address of one of a set of STAs 110 A-D that has already authenticated with the AP 108 A-I or another AP 108 A-I that is part of the same wireless protocol stack whether or not the destination address is the address of the AP 108 A-I itself).
- STA 110 A communicates with APs 108 A and 108 B
- STA 110 B communicates with APs 108 B and 108 E
- STA 110 C communicates with APs 108 D, 108 E, and 108 H
- STA 110 D communicates with APs 108 E and 108 H.
- the STAs 110 A-D and APs 108 A-I can communicate with other APs 108 A-I and STAs 110 A-D.
- the multipoint environment 100 has no pre-defined AP 108 A-I to which a STA 110 A-D is associated.
- the AP 108 A-I transmitting a data packet to a particular STA 110 A-D can change on a packet-by-packet basis.
- the AP 108 D can transmit a first data packet to the STA 110 C at a first time
- the AP 108 E can transmit a second data packet to the STA 110 C at a second time
- the AP 108 H can transmit a third data packet to the STA 110 C at a third time
- the AP 108 D can transmit a fourth data packet to the STA 110 C at a fourth time, and so on.
- the AP 108 A-I that transmits a data packet to the STA 110 A-D can change without the STA 110 A-D changing BSSs to which the STA 110 A-D is associated—the STA 110 A-D may remain in the same BSS using the same, single wireless stack while the AP 108 A-I that transmits data packets to the STA 110 A-D changes.
- the AP controller 106 can be configured to select the AP 108 A-I to transmit a data packet to a STA 110 A-D. For example, the AP controller 106 can route traffic to one or more APs 108 A-I for transmission to one or more STAs 110 A-D based on downlink and/or uplink quality measurements.
- a downlink (DL) transmission generally refers to a communication from a network system (e.g., an AP) to a user terminal (e.g., a STA).
- An uplink (UL) transmission generally refers to a communication from the user terminal to the network system.
- base station functionality is subdivided between the baseband unit 140 , the AP controller 106 , and/or multiple remote radio units (RRUs) (e.g., APs 108 A-I).
- RRUs may include multiple antennas, and one or more of the antennas may serve as a transmit-receive point (TRP).
- TRP transmit-receive point
- the RRU and/or a TRP may be referred to as a serving node, a base station, or an access point.
- the baseband unit 140 may be physically connected to the AP controller 106 and/or the RRUs, such as via an optical fiber connection.
- the baseband unit 140 and/or the AP controller 106 may provide operational details to an RRU to control transmission and reception of signals from the RRU along with control data and payload data to transmit.
- the RRU may provide data to the network received from STAs 110 A-D within a service area associated with the RRU.
- An RRU can provide service to devices (e.g., STAs 110 A-D) within a service area.
- wireless downlink transmission service may be provided by an RRU to the service area to communicate data to one or more devices within the service area.
- the APs 108 A-I may each have one or more transmit antennas that each support one or more digital basebands. In some embodiments, each AP 108 A-I has the same number of transmit antennas. In other embodiments, some or all APs 108 a -I have a different number of transmit antennas than other APs 108 A-I. Thus, the APs 108 A-I may collectively be capable of transmitting N spatial beams, where N is the product of the number of APs 108 A-I in the multipoint environment 100 and the number of transmit antennas operated by a single AP 108 A-I. Similarly, each AP 108 A-I can have the same number or different number of receive antennas.
- the baseband unit 140 , the AP controller 106 , and/or the APs 108 A-I can be collectively referred to herein as a “network system.”
- OFDM orthogonal frequency-division multiplexing
- a radio access network may include one or more base stations associated with one or more evolved NodeBs (also commonly denoted as enhanced NodeBs, eNodeBs, or eNBs), next generation NodeBs (gNBs), or any other suitable NodeBs (xNBs).
- evolved NodeBs also commonly denoted as enhanced NodeBs, eNodeBs, or eNBs
- gNBs next generation NodeBs
- xNBs any other suitable NodeBs
- RNCs radio network controllers
- a base station provides a bridge between the wireless network and a core network such as the Internet. The base station may be included to facilitate exchange of data for the wireless communication devices of the wireless network.
- the wireless communication device may be referred to as a station (STA) (e.g., for wireless communication devices that communicate using the IEEE 802.11 standard).
- the wireless communication device may also be referred to as a UE (e.g., for wireless communication devices that communicate in a RAN).
- the STA may be a device used by a user such as a smartphone, a laptop, a tablet computer, cellular telephone, a wearable computing device such as smart glasses or a smart watch or an ear piece, one or more networked appliances (e.g., consumer networked appliances or industrial plant equipment), an industrial robot with connectivity, or a vehicle.
- the STA may include a sensor or other networked device configured to collect data and wirelessly provide the data to a device (e.g., server) connected to a core network such as the Internet.
- a device e.g., server
- a core network such as the Internet.
- Such devices may be referred to as Internet of Things devices (IoT devices).
- IoT devices Internet of Things devices
- the AP controller 106 can function as a router to route traffic between the baseband unit 140 and the APs 108 A-I.
- the AP controller 106 can implement a relatively small amount of buffering. This can contribute to the AP controller 106 routing data between the baseband unit 140 and the APs 108 A-I with low latency.
- the AP controller 106 can include any suitable hardware to implement the functionality described herein.
- the APs 108 A-I can be arranged as an array. All of the APs 108 A-I can be connected to the AP controller 106 . The APs 108 A-I can be connected to the AP controller 106 via wired or wireless connections. Each AP 108 A-I can buffer a relatively low amount of frames of data at a time. For example, an AP 108 A can buffer 1 or 2 frames of data at a time in certain applications. The frames can be relatively big frames. For example, one frame can include 100 to 150 Internet protocol (IP) packets.
- IP Internet protocol
- the APs 108 A-I are arranged to wirelessly communicate with STAs 110 A-D.
- the APs 108 A-I can communicate via any suitable wireless links, such as wireless local area network (WLAN) links.
- WLAN signals can have a shorter signal range than cellular signals. In some instances, the WLAN signals can have a range of about 300 feet or less. WLAN signals can have a range of about 150 feet or less in certain applications.
- An example of a WLAN link is a Wi-Fi link.
- the WLAN link can be implemented based on an IEEE 802.11 standard.
- the APs 108 A-I are networking hardware devices that include any suitable physical hardware to implement the functionalities disclosed herein. Although APs are described with reference to certain embodiments for illustrative purposes, any suitable principles and advantages described with references to access points can be implemented with any other suitable serving nodes of a network system.
- Wi-Fi links millimeter wave (mmW) wireless area network (WAN) links
- 5G fifth generation New Radio (NR) links in Frequency Range 2 (FR2) are examples of such suitable wireless links.
- FIG. 1B is a schematic diagram illustrating a wireless network 150 that includes the baseband unit 140 according to an embodiment.
- the APs 108 A-I may operate as RRUs or serving nodes, and the baseband unit 140 and/or the AP controller 106 (not shown) may select users (e.g., STAs 110 , STA 110 receive antennas, etc.) to be served by one or more APs 108 A-I over one or more time slots and/or over one or more spatial dimensions.
- users e.g., STAs 110 , STA 110 receive antennas, etc.
- the baseband unit 140 includes user data TX buffers 112 , the scheduler control 114 , a time/frequency resource allocation block 116 , an active set and beam management block 118 , a transceiver 120 , a CSI computation block 122 , an active set serving node update block 124 , and the channel state data store 130 .
- the baseband unit 140 can include any suitable physical hardware to implement the illustrated blocks.
- the baseband unit 140 can include a processor and computer readable storage to implement any suitable blocks shown in FIG. 1B .
- the wireless network 150 also includes the APs 108 A-I, one or more STAs 110 , and/or the AP controller 106 (not shown).
- the wireless network 150 optionally includes other APs 108 , not shown.
- the baseband unit 140 and/or the AP controller 106 includes a scheduler that selects users to serve over one or more spatial dimensions over one or more time slots, selects APs 108 A-I to serve user data, and schedules user data for wireless transmission between the APs 108 A-I and STAs 110 over various spatial dimensions (e.g., spatial beams, channels, etc.).
- the scheduler can schedule DL data traffic, UL data traffic, or both.
- the scheduler can schedule data from any suitable number of APs 108 to any suitable number of UEs 110 .
- the scheduler can include the user data queue TX buffers 112 , the scheduler control 114 , the time/frequency resource allocation block 116 , the active set and beam management block 118 , the CSI computation block 122 , the active set serving node update block 124 , and/or the channel state data store 130 .
- the transceiver 120 can provide a STA report received from the STA 110 to the scheduler.
- the STA report can include spatial beam link strengths, spatial beam link quality, and/or other CSI suitable for allowing the scheduler to schedule DL data transmissions and/or to schedule UL data transmissions.
- the CSI computation block 122 can compute CSI data from data in the STA report.
- the active set serving node update block 124 can determine an updated active set for one or more STAs 110 based on updated link strength information provided by the STA(s) 110 (e.g., provided by the STA(s) 110 in response to receiving DL data traffic).
- the active set serving node update block 124 can determine an updated active set for a subset of one or more antennas of a STA 110 .
- the active set serving node update block 124 can use any suitable metrics disclosed herein to update an active set associated with a STA 110 .
- the transceiver 120 can also provide a beam visibility report received from the STA 110 and/or AP 108 to the scheduler.
- the beam visibility report can indicate which AP 108 has started transmitting UL data to a STA 110 in response to a blockage, obstruction, or other interference. For example, one AP 108 may have initially been serving a STA 110 . Due to an obstruction or interference, however, another AP 108 may start serving the STA 110 instead.
- the beam visibility report can inform the scheduler of the new AP 108 that has started serving the STA 110 instead.
- the scheduler (e.g., the active set serving node update block 124 ) can use this information to determine an updated active set for the STA 110 (e.g., update information identifying the beam(s) serving the STA 110 , which may now include the beam from the new AP 108 serving the STA 110 , such that future DL transmissions to the STA 110 are completed using at least one of the identified beam(s)).
- update information identifying the beam(s) serving the STA 110 , which may now include the beam from the new AP 108 serving the STA 110 , such that future DL transmissions to the STA 110 are completed using at least one of the identified beam(s)).
- the beam visibility report can include information from a STA 110 indicating that the STA 110 cannot receive transmissions from a beam transmitted by an AP 108 originally assigned to serve the STA 110 , but that the STA 110 can receive transmissions from a beam transmitted by another AP 108 .
- the scheduler e.g., the active set serving node update block 124
- can use this information to determine an updated active set for the STA 110 e.g., update information identifying the beam(s) serving the STA 110 , which may now include the beam from the another AP 108 that the STA 110 can see, such that future DL transmissions to the STA 110 are completed using at least one of the identified beam(s)).
- the updated active set data is provided to the scheduler control 114 .
- the user data queue TX buffers 112 can provide user data (e.g., DL user data) to the scheduler control 114 .
- the scheduler control 114 provides user data to the transceiver 120 and also provides instructions to the time/frequency resource allocation block 116 .
- the time/frequency resource allocation block 116 can schedule timing and frequency of DL and/or UL data transmission from and/or to APs 108 (e.g., generate scheduling data), which can be forwarded to the APs 108 via the transceiver 120 and/or the AP controller 106 . This can avoid timing conflicts and conflicts in the frequency domain.
- the active set and beam management block 118 can select APs 108 and/or specific spatial beams offered by these APs 108 for providing wireless transmission services to STAs 110 , and create corresponding active sets for the STAs 110 .
- the active set and beam management block 118 can group DL data transmissions and manage beamforming from the APs 108 to the STAs 110 .
- the transceiver 120 provides data for transmission by the APs 108 to STAs 110 .
- the scheduler can cause a network system of the wireless network 150 to wirelessly transmit first user data to a first STA 110 across one or more spatial beams or spatial dimensions, to transmit second user data to a second STA 110 across one or more spatial beams or spatial dimensions, and so on.
- the scheduler can cause the transmissions of the first user data, the second user data, etc. to occur simultaneously and/or at different times.
- the scheduler can cause a network system of the wireless network 150 to wirelessly transmit user data to any suitable number of STAs 110 across one or more spatial beams or spatial dimensions served by one or more APs 108 .
- FIG. 2 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment 100 of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment 100 to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment.
- the STAs 110 and APs 108 in the multipoint environment 100 can each be configured to restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of the STA 110 or AP 108 , use a minimum receive (Rx) sensitivity level below which the STA 110 or AP 108 does not attempt to decode the header or preamble of a data packet, or both restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of the STA 110 or AP 108 and use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to decode the header or preamble of a data
- a STA 110 or AP 108 can decode the header or preamble of a detected data packet to determine whether the destination address included in the header or preamble matches an address (or wildcard address) of the STA 110 or AP 108 .
- the STA 110 or AP 108 can start searching for a new data packet without waiting for transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet to finish.
- the STA 110 or AP 108 can start a PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to detect transmissions of data packets (e.g., to begin detecting the transmission of a preamble, header, and/or data payload of a data packet).
- the STA 110 or AP 108 can decode the destination address included in the preamble or header. If the destination address does not match the address (or wildcard address) of the STA 110 or AP 108 , then the STA 110 or AP 108 can restart the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to attempt to detect the transmission of another packet, even before transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet is complete.
- the AP 108 A transmits a first portion of packet 202 at time T 1 to STA 110 A at (1).
- the first portion of the packet 202 may be the header or preamble of the packet 202 .
- the STA 110 A can detect the transmission and decode the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 202 at (2). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 202 , the STA 110 A determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) does not match the STA 110 A address at (3). As a result, the STA 110 A begins looking for a new packet without waiting for completion of the transmission of the packet 202 at (4). For example, the STA 110 A may begin searching for a new packet prior to the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of the packet 202 .
- the AP 108 B transmits a packet 204 to the STA 110 A at time T 2 at (5).
- the time T 2 may be after the time T 1 , but before the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of the packet 202 .
- the AP 108 A may transmit a second portion of the packet 202 to the STA 110 A at time T 3 at (6).
- the time T 3 may be after the time T 2 .
- the second portion of the packet 202 may be a subsequent part of the header, a subsequent part of the preamble, and/or the data payload of the packet 202 .
- the STA 110 A can decode the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 204 at (7). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 204 , the STA 110 A determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) matches the STA 110 A address at (8). The STA 110 A can then lock onto the packet 204 and process the remaining portion of the packet 204 .
- an AP 108 transmission can include a header, a payload, and a guard time that follows the payload to allow the STA 110 to transmit a positive acknowledgement (ACK) message or a negative acknowledgement (NAK) message.
- ACK positive acknowledgement
- NAK negative acknowledgement
- a STA 110 begins searching for a data packet. After successfully identifying and decoding a preamble or header of a data packet that has a destination address that matches the address of the STA 110 , the STA 110 continues to decode the payload.
- the STA 110 can transmit an ACK or NAK to the AP 108 that transmitted the data packet and/or to another AP 108 , such as another AP 108 that shares the same wireless protocol stack as the packet transmitted AP 108 as described herein. The STA 110 then begins searching for another data packet.
- a STA 110 begins searching for a data packet. After successfully identifying and decoding a preamble or header of a data packet that has a destination address that does not match the address of the STA 110 , the STA 110 aborts the payload decode and continues searching for a preamble or header of another data packet.
- a STA 110 B begins searching for a data packet. After successfully identifying and decoding an ACK and/or NAK transmitted by another STA 110 A, the STA 110 B finishes processing the ACK and/or NAK and continues searching for another data packet.
- Pre-empting full data packet processing in a manner as described above with respect to FIG. 2 and elsewhere in this disclosure can reduce the likelihood that a STA 110 misses a transmission from an AP 108 that is intended for the STA 110 and that is transmitted while the STA 110 is processing a false alarm data packet (e.g., a data packet not intended for the STA 110 , a data packet intended for another STA 110 , a data packet transmitted by an AP 108 with which the STA 110 has not authenticated, etc.).
- a false alarm data packet e.g., a data packet not intended for the STA 110 , a data packet intended for another STA 110 , a data packet transmitted by an AP 108 with which the STA 110 has not authenticated, etc.
- a STA 110 may still miss some transmissions intended for the STA 110 .
- the header of a data packet intended for a STA 110 may be missed if the STA 110 is processing the header of a data packet not intended for the STA 110 .
- Such overlap may be possible because traditional AP 108 transmissions may not be synchronized or even temporarily coordinated.
- FIGS. 13-15 below describe in greater detail additional operations that can be performed by the AP controller 106 , some or all of the APs 108 A-I, and/or some or all of the STAs 110 A-D to further reduce the likelihood that data packet transmissions intended for a STA 110 are missed by the STA 110 .
- FIG. 3 is another block diagram of the multipoint environment 100 of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment 100 to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment.
- the operations depicted in FIG. 3 are directed to the data packet detection procedure restart described herein being performed by an AP 108 .
- the STA 110 A transmits a first portion of packet 302 at time T 1 to AP 108 B at (1).
- the first portion of the packet 302 may be the header or preamble of the packet 302 .
- the AP 108 B can detect the transmission and decode the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 302 at (2). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 302 , the AP 108 B determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) does not match the AP 108 B address or the wildcard address associated with the AP 108 B at (3).
- the AP 108 B begins looking for a new packet without waiting for completion of the transmission of the packet 302 at (4).
- the AP 108 B may begin searching for a new packet prior to the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of the packet 302 .
- the STA 110 B transmits a packet 304 to the AP 108 B at time T 2 at (5).
- the time T 2 may be after the time T 1 , but before the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of the packet 302 .
- the STA 110 A may transmit a second portion of the packet 302 to the AP 108 B at time T 3 at (6).
- the time T 3 may be after the time T2.
- the second portion of the packet 302 may be a subsequent part of the header, a subsequent part of the preamble, and/or the data payload of the packet 302 .
- the AP 108 B can decode the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 304 at (7). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 304 , the AP 108 B determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) matches the AP 108 B address or the wildcard address associated with the AP 108 B at (8). The AP 108 B can then lock onto the packet 304 and process the remaining portion of the packet 304 .
- a STA 110 can provide to an AP 108 information identifying a false alarm when the STA 110 attempts to decode a data packet only to find that the destination address of the data packet does not match the address of the STA 110 .
- the AP 108 can gather information for one or more false alarms identified by the STA 110 (e.g., the STA 110 can transmit, at separate times or at once, information for one or more false alarms identified by the STA 110 ), and use this information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 .
- the AP 108 and/or the AP controller 106 can determine a statistic (e.g., the mean, median, mode, etc.) of the received power level (e.g., a power level at which a data packet is received) of the data packets that the STA 110 identified as resulting in a false alarm, and the AP 108 and/or AP controller 106 can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 to be some level above the determined statistic (e.g., some level above the mean, median, mode, etc.) of the received power level of the data packets that the STA 110 identified as resulting in a false alarm.
- a statistic e.g., the mean, median, mode, etc.
- the APs 108 can analyze the source address included in a header or preamble of a data packet instead of the destination address to minimize the negative effects of false alarms, and otherwise perform some or all of the other operations described herein.
- the APs 108 in the multipoint environment 100 can each be configured to restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the source address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the source address does not match an address of a STA 110 that has authenticated with one or more of the APs 108 , use a minimum receive (Rx) sensitivity level below which the AP 108 does not attempt to decode the header or preamble of a data packet, or both restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the source address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the source address does not match an address an authenticated STA 110 and use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to decode the header or preamble of a data packet.
- Rx minimum receive
- an AP 108 may start processing and/or decoding a data packet if the AP 108 determines that the source address included in the header or preamble of the data packet matches an address of an authenticated STA 110 (e.g., a STA 110 that has authenticated with the AP 108 , the AP 108 or another AP 108 in a group of APs 108 has authenticated the STA 110 , etc.) and/or has a minimum Rx sensitivity level.
- an authenticated STA 110 e.g., a STA 110 that has authenticated with the AP 108 , the AP 108 or another AP 108 in a group of APs 108 has authenticated the STA 110 , etc.
- an AP 108 can decode the header or preamble of a detected data packet to determine whether the source address included in the header or preamble matches an address of an authenticated STA 110 . If the source address in the header or preamble matches an address of an authenticated STA 110 , the AP 108 locks onto the data packet and continues to process the remaining portion of the data packet, irrespective of whether the destination address included in the header or preamble of the data packet matches the address of the AP 108 .
- the AP 108 can start searching for a new data packet without waiting for transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet to finish.
- the AP 108 can start a PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to detect transmissions of data packets (e.g., to begin detecting the transmission of a preamble, header, and/or data payload of a data packet).
- the AP 108 can decode the source address included in the preamble or header. If the source address does not match the address of an authenticated STA 110 , then the AP 108 can restart the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to attempt to detect the transmission of another packet, even before transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet is complete.
- FIG. 4 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment 100 of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment 100 to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA 110 A using false alarm information according to an embodiment. While the operations depicted in FIG. 4 are directed to determining a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA 110 , similar techniques can be used to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for an AP 108 .
- the AP 108 A transmits packet 402 at time T 1 to the STA 110 A at (1).
- the AP 108 A may initially transmit a header or preamble of the packet 402 .
- the STA 110 A can detect the transmission and decode the header (and/or preamble) of the packet 402 at (2).
- the STA 110 A determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) does not match the STA 110 A address at (3). As a result, the STA 110 A provides information to the AP 108 A identifying the false alarm at (4).
- the information can include the received power level of the packet 402 (e.g., a power level at which the packet 402 is received by the STA 110 A), a destination address included in the packet 402 , a time that the packet 402 was received by the STA 110 A, and/or the like.
- the STA 110 A may also begin looking for a new packet without waiting for completion of the transmission of the packet 402 .
- the STA 110 A may begin searching for a new packet prior to the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of the packet 402 .
- the AP 108 A can determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 A at (5). For example, the AP 108 A can average the data packet received power level(s) included in the received false alarm information, and select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 A that is at least some value above the average data packet received power level.
- the AP 108 A can determine a median data packet received power level, a mode data packet received power level, a standard deviation of the data packet received power level(s), a variance of the data packet received power level(s), etc., and select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 A that is at least some value over the determined data packet received power level statistic. Once the minimum Rx sensitivity level is determined, the AP 108 A transmits the minimum Rx sensitivity level to the STA 110 A at (6).
- the STA 110 A can now use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to begin decoding a data packet. For example, the AP 108 B can transmit a packet 404 at a time T 2 that is some time after the time T 1 at (7). The STA 110 A may detect the transmission of the packet 404 , but may ignore the packet 404 at (8) (e.g., decline to decode the header and/or preamble of the packet 404 ) because the received power level of the packet 404 is below the minimum Rx sensitivity level.
- the AP 108 can gather information for one or more missed detects (e.g., data packet transmissions intended for a STA 110 that were not received by the STA 110 ) and use this information alone or with the false alarm information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 .
- the AP 108 can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be some level below a statistic (e.g., a mean, median, mode, etc.) of a transmission power level of the data packets intended for the STA 110 that were not received by the STA 110 .
- a statistic e.g., a mean, median, mode, etc.
- the AP 108 can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be some level below a statistic of a transmission power level of the data packets intended for the STA 110 that were not received by the STA 110 minus an estimated path loss from the AP 108 to the STA 110 (where the path loss may be estimated by the AP 108 and/or the STA 110 ).
- the AP 108 can then provide the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to the STA 110 so that the STA 110 can begin using the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet.
- an AP 108 can use missed detect information obtained from a STA 110 (e.g., information identifying data packets intended for the AP 108 that were not received by the AP 108 ) and/or false alarm information determined by the AP 108 (e.g., information associated with data packets decoded by the AP 108 that were not intended for the AP 108 ) to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for itself in a similar manner. The AP 108 can then use the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet.
- missed detect information obtained from a STA 110 e.g., information identifying data packets intended for the AP 108 that were not received by the AP 108
- false alarm information determined by the AP 108 e.g., information associated with data packets decoded by the AP 108 that were not intended for the AP 108
- the AP 108 can then use the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to
- FIG. 5 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment 100 of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment 100 to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA 110 A using missed detect information according to an embodiment. While the operations depicted in FIG. 5 are directed to determining a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA 110 , similar techniques can be used to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for an AP 108 .
- the AP 108 A transmits a packet 502 that includes a destination address of the STA 110 A at time T 1 at (1).
- the AP 108 A can detect that the STA 110 A did not receive the packet 502 at (2).
- the AP 108 A may detect that the STA 110 A did not receive the packet 502 because the STA 110 A did not transmit an acknowledgement message to the AP 108 A acknowledging receipt of the packet 502 within a threshold period of time after time T 1 .
- the AP 108 A can generate missed detect information, which includes a transmission power level of the packet 502 (and/or a power level at which the packet 502 should have been received by the STA 110 A), a time that the packet 502 was transmitted, a destination address of the packet 502 , and/or the like.
- the AP 108 A can use the generated missed detect information and/or missed detect information derived from one or more other data packets transmitted to, but not received by, the STA 110 A to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA 110 A at (3).
- the AP 108 A can average the transmission power level(s) of the data packets transmitted to, but not received by, the STA 110 A, and set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be at most some level below the average transmission power level (e.g., at most some level below the average transmission power level minus the estimated path loss from the AP 108 A to the STA 110 A).
- the AP 108 A can determine a median transmission power level, a mode transmission power level, a standard deviation of the transmission power level(s), a variance of the transmission power level(s), and/or the like of the data packets transmitted to, but not received by, the STA 110 A, and set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be at most some level below the statistic of the transmission power level (e.g., at most some level below the statistic of the transmission power level minus the estimated path loss from the AP 108 A to the STA 110 A). Once the minimum Rx sensitivity level is determined, the AP 108 A transmits the minimum Rx sensitivity level to the STA 110 A at (4).
- the STA 110 A can now use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to begin decoding a data packet. For example, the AP 108 b can transmit a packet 504 at a time T 2 that is some time after the time T 1 at (5). The STA 110 A may detect the transmission of the packet 504 , but may ignore the packet 504 at (6) (e.g., decline to decode the header and/or preamble of the packet 504 ) because the received power level (or transmission power level) of the packet 504 is below the minimum Rx sensitivity level.
- the AP controller 106 can determine the minimum Rx sensitivity level.
- the AP controller 106 can determine the minimum Rx sensitivity level in the same manner as the AP 108 as described herein.
- the multipoint environment 100 By configuring a STA 110 or AP 108 to restart the data packet detection procedure soon after identifying that a destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of a STA 110 or AP 108 and/or to use a minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet, the multipoint environment 100 increases the reliability and reduces the latency of a wireless network. For example, reliability may be increased because a STA 110 or AP 108 is less likely to miss a data packet intended for the STA 110 or AP 108 given that the STA 110 or AP 108 is no longer waiting for transmission of a data packet to finish before searching for a new data packet.
- Latency of the wireless network may be reduced because a STA 110 or AP 108 may no longer decode all detected data packets. Rather, the STA 110 or AP 108 may only decode those data packets that have a received power level over a minimum Rx sensitivity level, which may cause the STA 110 or AP 108 to decode sooner those data packets actually intended for the STA 110 or AP 108 .
- the AP controller 106 may further increase reliability and reduce latency in the wireless network by implementing retransmission diversity. For example, transmission of a data packet from an AP 108 to a STA 110 or from a STA 110 to an AP 108 may fail due to an obstruction (e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.) and/or interference (e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP 108 or STA 110 ) being present. Generally, the data packet may be retransmitted in response to the initial transmission failure.
- an obstruction e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.
- interference e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP 108 or STA 110
- Retransmitting the data packet from the same STA 110 or AP 108 is likely to result in another transmission failure, however, because retransmissions generally occur soon after the initial transmission (e.g., 1 ms after, 10 ms after, 100 ms after, etc.) and the obstruction and/or interference is still likely to be present given the short timeframe between transmissions.
- the AP controller 106 can trigger a retransmission of the data packet from another STA 110 or AP 108 , such as from a STA 110 or AP 108 that has a different spatial location than the STA 110 or AP 108 that originally transmitted the data packet.
- the AP controller 106 can trigger a retransmission of the data packet by a second AP 108 in place of the first AP 108 , where the second AP 108 may have a different spatial location than the first AP 108 .
- the AP controller 106 can pre-cache a data packet at one or more APs 108 , even before the AP 108 that is originally assigned to transmit the data packet transmits the data packet. For example, there may be a time delay involved in an AP controller 106 transmitting a data packet to an AP 108 so that the AP 108 can transmit the data packet to a STA 110 . Pre-caching the data packet at multiple APs 108 before the data packet is transmitted by any AP 108 (and therefore before a transmission failure occurs) may reduce the time it takes for a second AP 108 to retransmit the data packet if the first transmission of the data packet fails.
- the AP controller 106 can instruct a second AP 108 at which the data packet has already been pre-cached to transmit the data packet.
- the time waiting for the second AP 108 to receive the data packet from the AP controller 106 is therefore eliminated.
- the time from when the AP controller 106 determines that the second AP 108 should retransmit the data packet to when the second AP 108 retransmits the data packet is reduced, thereby reducing the latency involved with retransmitting the data packet.
- FIGS. 6A-6B are block diagrams of the multipoint environment 100 of FIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment 100 to pre-cache data packets according to an embodiment.
- the AP controller 106 pre-caches a data packet 602 at the AP 108 A and instructs the AP controller 106 .
- the AP controller 106 can pre-cache the packet 602 at the AP 108 A by transmitting the packet 602 data to the AP 108 A. Before, during, and/or after pre-caching the packet 602 at the AP 108 A, the AP controller 106 pre-caches the packet 602 at the AP 108 B. The AP controller 106 , however, does not immediately instruct the AP 108 B to transmit the packet 602 .
- the AP 108 A can transmit the packet 602 with a destination address of the STA 110 A at (2).
- the AP 108 A may detect that the STA 110 A did not receive the packet at (3) because, for example, no acknowledgement message was received from the STA 110 A acknowledging receipt of the packet 602 .
- the AP 108 A can transmit to the AP controller 106 an indication that the STA 110 A did not receive the packet 602 at (4).
- the AP controller 106 can then instruct the AP 108 B to transmit the packet 602 at (5), and the AP 108 B can transmit the packet 602 to the STA 110 A at (6).
- the AP controller 106 can optionally transmit an indication to the baseband unit 140 that the AP 108 B is transmitting to the STA 110 A in place of the AP 108 A at (7).
- the baseband unit 140 can use this information to schedule future data packets to the STA 110 A to be served by the AP 108 B instead of the AP 108 A, at least until the next active set selection procedure is performed to select one or more APs 108 and/or one or more beams to serve the STA 110 A.
- the STA 110 A can transmit to the AP 108 B an indication that the STA 110 A is not seeing a beam from the AP 108 A that was originally assigned in an active set to serve the STA 110 A at (8).
- the STA 110 A may further indicate a beam that the STA 110 A can see from another AP, such as from the AP 108 B.
- the AP 108 B can forward this indication to the AP controller 106 at (9), and the AP controller 106 can forward this indication to the baseband unit 140 at (10).
- the baseband unit 140 can use this information to schedule future data packets to the STA 110 A to be served by a beam other than the beam of the AP 108 A originally assigned in active set to serve the STA 110 A.
- the other beam may be the beam from the AP 108 B that the STA 110 A can see or detect.
- This beam may be temporarily assigned to the STA 110 A until the next active set selection procedure is performed to select one or more APs 108 and/or one or more beams to serve the STA 110 A.
- the baseband unit 140 uses the updated AP 108 serving information provided by the AP controller 106 and/or the beam information provided by the STA 110 A to provide to the AP controller 106 data for a new packet 604 and an instruction to instruct the AP 108 B (and/or a particular beam of the AP 108 B) to transmit the packet 604 at (11).
- new packets can be transmitted to the STA 110 A in a manner that may avoid the obstruction or interference causing transmission issues.
- FIG. 7 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine 700 illustratively implemented by a STA and/or an AP, according to one embodiment.
- a STA 110 A-D and/or an AP 108 A-I can be configured to execute the packet detection routine 700 .
- the packet detection routine 700 begins at block 702 .
- a header (and/or a preamble) of a first packet is decoded.
- the header and/or preamble of the first packet may be decoded in order to determine whether the packet is intended for the decoding device (e.g., a STA 110 or an AP 108 ).
- the destination address may not match a STA 110 address or the destination address may not match an AP 108 address or a wildcard address associated with an AP 108 .
- the device begins to look for another packet before transmission of the first packet is complete. For example, rather than waiting for transmission of the first packet is complete before looking for another packet, the STA 110 or AP 108 can immediate unlock from the first packet upon determining that the destination address does not match the address or wildcard address of the STA 110 or AP 108 .
- FIG. 8 is a flow diagram depicting a minimum Rx sensitivity selection routine 800 illustratively implemented by an AP, an AP controller, and/or a STA according to one embodiment.
- the AP 108 , the AP controller 106 , and/or the STA 110 can be configured to execute the minimum Rx sensitivity selection routine 800 .
- the minimum Rx sensitivity selection routine 800 begins at block 802 .
- a packet is transmitted to a device.
- the packet can be transmitted to a STA 110 or an AP 108 .
- information is received indicating that a false alarm occurred.
- the information can be received by an AP 108 from a STA 110 or can be generated by the AP 108 in response to a packet transmitted by a STA 110 .
- the information can include an indication of a received power level of the packet.
- a minimum Rx sensitivity level is determined for the device based at least in part on the received information.
- the minimum Rx sensitivity level may be based on the received information and previously received false alarm information associated with previously transmitted packets to the device.
- the minimum Rx sensitivity level may be set to a level that is at least some level above the received power level of the packet and/or at least some level above a statistic derived from the received power level of the packet and/or received power level(s) of other transmitted packet(s).
- the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level is transmitted to the device.
- the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level can be transmitted to a STA 110 .
- the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level can be transmitted to an AP 108 from an AP controller 106 . This operation may be optional if, for example, the AP 108 determines a minimum Rx sensitivity level for itself.
- FIG. 9 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine 900 illustratively implemented by a STA, according to one embodiment.
- a STA 110 A-D can be configured to execute the packet detection routine 900 .
- the packet detection routine 900 begins at block 902 .
- authentication with one or more access points is performed.
- the STA may request to be authenticated with any one of multiple access points in a single wireless protocol stack.
- a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a first access point in the one or more access points is decoded.
- the first portion of the first packet may be a header or preamble of the first packet.
- the address can be the Internet protocol (IP) address of the STA.
- the first packet is processed in response to the determination that the destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the wireless computing device, irrespective of a source address included in the first portion of the first packet.
- the STA can lock onto and process the remaining portion of the first packet (e.g., the data payload of the first packet) in response to determining that the destination address in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the STA.
- FIG. 10 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine 1000 illustratively implemented by an AP, according to one embodiment.
- an AP 108 A-I can be configured to execute the packet detection routine 1000 .
- the packet detection routine 1000 begins at block 1002 .
- a wireless communication device is authenticated.
- the wireless communication device can be a STA.
- the wireless communication device may be authenticated in response to a request from the wireless communication device. Authentication by the AP 108 A-I may result in the wireless communication device being authenticated with the AP 108 A-I and/or with one or more other APs 108 A-I that are within a single wireless protocol stack.
- a first portion of a first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device is decoded.
- the first portion of the first packet may be a header or preamble of the first packet.
- the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a source address in a header or preamble of the first packet.
- the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a wildcard address associated with the AP, which can be the address of the wireless computing device (e.g., a STA).
- the address associated with the wireless communication device is an address of the wireless communication device.
- the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a source address that matches the address of the wireless communication device.
- the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a source address that matches the address of the authenticated wireless communication device.
- the first packet is processed in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless computing device, irrespective of whether the first packet includes an address of the access point.
- the AP can lock onto and process the remaining portion of the first packet (e.g., the data payload of the first packet) in response to determining that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless computing device.
- the AP can process the first packet whether the first portion of the first packet includes the address of the AP as a destination address.
- the destination address could be a wildcard address, the address of another AP, or the address of the AP.
- the AP can verify that the wireless communication device is authenticated (e.g., authenticated with the AP and/or with one or more other APs in the same wireless protocol stack) and process the first packet in response to the determination that the wireless communication device is authenticated and in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless computing device.
- authenticated e.g., authenticated with the AP and/or with one or more other APs in the same wireless protocol stack
- FIG. 11 is a block diagram illustrating an example baseband unit 1102 and remote radio unit 1190 according to an embodiment.
- the baseband unit 1102 may be coupled with at least one remote radio unit 1190 .
- the remote radio unit 1190 may include at least a first antenna 1196 and a second antenna 1198 for MIMO wireless communications. Any antenna disclosed herein, such as the antenna 1196 or the antenna 1198 , can be referred to as antenna element.
- the first antenna 1196 and the second antenna 1198 may be coupled with a RF front end 1194 .
- the RF front end 1194 may process signals received via the first antenna 1196 and the second antenna 1198 . Part of processing a signal may include transmitting the signal to a transceiver 1120 included in the BBU 1102 .
- a processor 1105 may receive signals received by the transceiver 1120 .
- the processor 1105 may be configured to determine a type of the signal. For example, if the signal includes a request for connection services, the processor 1105 may provide the signal to an active set selector 1135 .
- the active set selector 1135 may be configured to identify an active set of serving nodes to provide the requested downlink data transmission service.
- the active set selector 1135 can identify the active set for a STA based on information associated with the STA. Alternatively or additionally, the active set selector 1135 can identify the active set for a STA based on information associated with one or more other STAs. In some instances, the active set selector 1135 can identify specific spatial beam(s) selected to serve a STA.
- the BBU 1102 may include a network monitor 1125 to detect characteristics of the network such as the number of STAs served by each RRU, network data transmission load, and/or the like.
- the active set selector 1135 may receive the network characteristics from the network monitor 1125 as a factor considered when selecting spatial beam(s) to serve a STA and/or identifying an active set for a STA.
- a beamformer 1115 may be included in the BBU 1102 to further identify parameters for the serving nodes (e.g., RRUs) included in an active set.
- the parameters may include one or more of transmission mode, time, frequency, power, beamforming matrix, tone allocation, or channel rank.
- the beamformer 1115 may determine optimal parameters for RRUs coupled with the BBU 1102 that facilitate a network-wide optimization of downlink data transmissions.
- the active set selector 1135 determines an active set for a STA based, in part, on information provided by the STA. In other implementations, a UE may provide a requested active set.
- the BBU 1102 may include an active set arbitrator 1130 to reconcile a requested active set with an active set selected by the active set selector 1135 .
- the active set arbitrator 1130 may compare a requested set of serving nodes to the serving nodes identified by the active set selector 1135 . The comparison may include ordering the serving nodes according to the STA recommendation.
- the active set arbitrator 1130 may provide a message to the STA indicating confirmation or other assessment for a requested active set. For example, if the STA requested nodes A and B but the BBU 1102 identified only B in the active set, the message may include a code indicating a partial match for the active set. Other status codes may be included to facilitate efficient communication and assessment of requested active sets.
- the active set arbitrator 1130 may additionally or alternatively compare a requested transmission mode to the transmission mode identified by the active set selector 1135 or other element of the BBU 1102 .
- the BBU 1102 may include a data store 1110 .
- the data store 1110 may include instructions that can be executed by the processor 1105 to implement the features described herein.
- the data store 1110 may retain active sets or other scheduling information assigned to STAs served by the BBU 1102 and/or channel state information.
- the data store 1110 may be indexed by STA identifier and/or RRU identifier. This can expedite identification of previously communicated scheduling information for the STA and for monitoring network conditions (e.g., number of STAs allocated to an RRU or antenna element of an RRU).
- the scheduling information may be used to configure the RRU 1190 .
- the configuration may include adjusting the first antenna 1196 such as by frequency modulation, time modulation, altering transmission power from a power source 1192 , or adjusting direction, tone allocation, or beamforming of the transmission.
- STAs can wirelessly communicate with serving nodes in a cooperative MIMO network.
- An example STA will be discussed with reference to FIG. 12 .
- FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example STA 1200 according to an embodiment.
- the STA 1200 is configured for wirelessly communicating with a base station in a cooperative MIMO network.
- the STA 1200 includes a processor 1240 , a user interface 1245 , a data store 1250 , a beamformer 1255 , antennas 1262 and 1264 , a transceiver 1265 , a motion detector 1270 , a signal quality analyzer 1275 , and an active set selector 1280 .
- Some other STAs can include additional elements and/or a subset of the elements illustrated in FIG. 12 .
- the STA 1200 includes a plurality of antennas 1262 and 1264 . Any suitable number of antennas can be included for wireless communication.
- the STA 1200 can include one or more arrays of antennas.
- a radio frequency (RF) front end 1260 can process RF signals received via the antennas 1262 and 1264 .
- the RF front end can also provide RF signals to the antennas 1262 and 1264 for transmission.
- the transceiver 1265 includes a transmitter and a receiver.
- the transceiver 1265 can provide processing for transmitting and receiving RF signals associated with the antennas 1262 and 1264 .
- the processor 1240 can configure the transceiver 1265 (e.g., receiver) to receive DL data associated with the spatial beam(s) identified in the active set data as being selected to serve the STA 1200 .
- the processor 1240 is in communication with the transceiver 1265 .
- the processor 1240 is implemented by physical hardware arranged to perform specific operations to implement functionality related to determining a link strength of spatial beams over which beam pilots and/or user data are transmitted.
- the processor 1240 can determine the link strength, identify a spatial beam that provides the best link strength, and/or generate one or more messages to report the link strength to a serving node in accordance with any suitable principles and advantages disclosed herein.
- the processor 1240 can cause active set and neighbor set data to be stored and updated.
- the processor 1240 can perform any other suitable processing for the STA 1200 .
- the processor 1240 can be in communication with the motion detector 1270 and the signal quality analyzer 1275 . Accordingly, the processor 1240 can receive and process information associated with conditions of the STA 1200 .
- the motion detector 1270 can include any suitable hardware arranged to detect mobility information associated with the STA 1200 .
- the signal quality analyzer 1275 can analyze the quality of signals received and/or transmitted by the antennas 1262 and 1264 . This can provide information associated with a spatial channel condition of the STA 1200 .
- the information associated with conditions of the STA 1200 can be provided to the processor 1240 for providing to the serving node(s). In some instances, some or all of the functionality of the motion detector 1270 and/or the signal quality analyzer can be implemented by the processor 1240 .
- the active set selector 1280 is optional and can identify a desired active set of one or more serving nodes.
- the active set selector 1280 can select the desired active set based on data associated with one or more of: one or more serving nodes in the active set, one or more serving nodes in the neighbor set, mobility data associated with the UE 1200 , a spatial channel condition associated with the STA 1200 , the link strength and/or the link quality of one or more spatial beams served by one or more serving nodes, or one or more characteristics of the STA 1200 .
- the active set selector 1280 can optionally execute the active set management scheme to identify a desired active set.
- the active set selector 1280 can cause the processor 1240 to generate a message for transmission to a serving node and/or a BBU to request that a selected spatial beam (or selected spatial beams) be added to an active set for the STA 1200 (e.g., request that a selected spatial beam, which may be different than the spatial beam(s) already included in an active set for the STA 1200 , be included in an updated active set for the STA 1200 ).
- the active set selector 1280 can be implemented by dedicated circuitry and/or circuitry of the processor 1240 .
- the beamformer 1255 can perform any suitable beamforming functionality for the STA 1200 .
- the beamformer 1255 can set and/or adjust one or more parameters associated with receiving and/or transmitting signals associated with the antennas 1262 and 1264 of the STA 1200 .
- the beamformer 1255 can be implemented by dedicated circuitry and/or circuitry of the processor 1240 .
- the STA 1240 includes a data store 1250 .
- the data store 1250 can store instructions that can be executed by the processor 1240 to implement the features described herein.
- the data store 1250 can store active set data and neighbor set data for the STA 1200 .
- the data store 1250 can store spatial beam link strengths and/or link qualities.
- the data store 1250 can store any other suitable data for the STA 1200 .
- the data store 1250 can include any suitable memory elements arranged to store data.
- the bus 1290 can be a data bus, communication bus, other bus, or any suitable combination thereof to enable the various components of the STA 1200 to exchange information.
- the STA 1200 also includes a user interface 1245 .
- the user interface 1245 can be any suitable user interface, such as a display and/or an audio component.
- the user interface 1245 can include one or more of touch screen capabilities, a button, a knob, a switch, or a slider.
- a STA 110 may miss a data packet transmission intended for the STA 110 if the STA 110 is decoding a preamble or header of another data packet while the header or preamble of desired data packet is being transmitted.
- FIG. 13 illustrates an example timeline for packet transmissions from an AP 108 to a STA 110 , depicting reasons why a data packet transmission miss may occur.
- a STA 110 begins searching for a data packet at (1). After successfully identifying a data packet, the STA 110 may decode a preamble or header of the data packet and determine that the preamble or header has a destination address that matches the address of the STA 110 at (2). The STA 110 may then continue decoding the payload of the data packet at (3). Once the preamble or header and/or payload are decoded and a guard time has passed, the STA 110 can transmit an ACK or NAK at (4) to the AP 108 that transmitted the data packet and/or to another AP 108 , such as another AP 108 that shares the same wireless protocol stack as the packet transmitted AP 108 as described herein.
- the STA 110 then begins searching for another data packet at (5).
- the total transmission and/or processing time from transmission of the beginning of the header to transmission of the end of the ACK may be time T x .
- the transmission time for the STA 110 to transmit the ACK or NAK may be T a .
- a STA 110 begins searching for a data packet at (6). After successfully identifying a data packet, the STA 110 may decode a preamble or header of a data packet and determine that the preamble or header has a destination address that does not match the address of the STA 110 at (7). The STA 110 then aborts the payload decode and continues searching at (8) for a preamble or header of another data packet.
- the total transmission and/or processing time from the transmission of the beginning of the header to the start of the search at (8) is time T d .
- a STA 110 B begins searching for a data packet at (9). After successfully identifying and decoding an ACK and/or NAK transmitted by another STA 110 A, the STA 110 B finishes processing the ACK and/or NAK at (10) and continues searching for another data packet at (11).
- the total transmission and/or processing time from the transmission of the beginning of the ACK and/or NAK to the start of the search at (11) may be time T ap .
- the difference between T ap and T a may be the time beyond the transmission of the ACK and/or NAK for the STA 110 B to complete the processing of the ACK and/or NAK and restart the search processing at (11).
- pre-empting full data packet processing in a manner as described above with respect to FIG. 2 and elsewhere in this disclosure can reduce the likelihood that a STA 110 misses a transmission from an AP 108 that is intended for the STA 110 and that is transmitted while the STA 110 is processing a false alarm data packet (e.g., a data packet not intended for the STA 110 , a data packet intended for another STA 110 , a data packet transmitted by an AP 108 with which the STA 110 has not authenticated, etc.).
- a STA 110 may still miss some transmissions intended for the STA 110 as depicted in FIG. 13 . Synchronizing and/or temporarily coordinating APs 108 may alleviate this issue.
- FIG. 14 illustrates a synchronized system in which AP 108 packet transmission times are synchronized to a raster.
- the AP 108 A-C transmission start times may be offset on a raster with spacing time T r .
- an AP 108 may transmit a data packet at start time index n if
- the raster may ensure that one AP 108 is transmitting a header during any raster interval (e.g., multiple APs 108 may not transmit a header during the same raster interval).
- a STA 110 detects a preamble for a data packet not intended for the STA 110 , as long as the STA 110 can process and/or abort the processing of the header prior to the next raster start time, the STA 110 may not miss a preamble of a data packet actually intended for the STA 110 (e.g., given that subsequent preambles may be transmitted by APs 108 after the prior raster start time completes).
- the STAs 110 can continue to process preambles or headers in a manner as described herein, and abort the processing if the destination address in the header or preamble does not match the address of the respective STA 110 .
- the APs 108 may be coordinated such that the APs 108 refrain from transmitting preambles or headers at the same time and/or overlapping in time. This may ensure that, at least due to AP 108 preamble false alarms, the STAs 110 are in a search state at the beginning of a raster interval if the STAs 110 are not already processing a data packet that is directed to the respective STA 110 . These operations may reduce the likelihood that STAs 110 miss data packets due to the processing of preambles or headers that are for data packets not actually intended for the STAs 110 .
- AP 108 A may start 1402 transmitting a header or preamble of a data packet at time 0. Because FIG. 14 illustrates three APs 108 A-C in the network, the next raster interval during which the AP 108 A can transmit is time 3T r . At time 3T r , the AP 108 A transmits a header 1404 and, some time later, transmits a payload 1406 of a second data packet. AP 108 B, however, may start transmitting preambles or headers at time T r and AP 108 C may start transmitting preambles or headers at time 2T r .
- the data packet transmitted by the AP 108 B at time T r may be large and the amount of time to transmit the full data packet may pass the next raster interval, 4T r , assigned to the AP 108 B. As a result, the AP 108 B may not transmit a second packet until the following raster interval, 7T r . Similarly, while the AP 108 C can transmit during the raster interval starting at 2T r , the AP 108 C does not need to transmit during this raster interval. Here, the AP 108 C does not transmit any data packets during this raster interval. The AP 108 C then waits until the next raster interval, 5T r , to transmit a preamble or header and payload of a data packet.
- the raster step T r may be at least equal to the maximum time, T d , for a STA 110 to process and abort processing a preamble that has a mismatched destination (e.g., has a destination address that does not match the address of the STA 110 ).
- T d the maximum time
- the raster time interval, T r may be as follows:
- the AP controller 106 could assign every AP 108 A-C in a system a unique raster offset or interval.
- the period of start times for a given AP may be N*T r .
- the AP controller 106 can assign APs 108 the same offset if the APs 108 are sufficiently spaced from a path loss perspective.
- the APs 108 A-B could be assigned the same offset given that it is unlikely that the STAs 110 associated with AP 108 B will process preambles or headers of data packets transmitted by the AP 108 A since such data packets may be below a configured minimum sensitivity threshold (e.g., such as the minimum Rx sensitivity level described above).
- These operations may be a form of raster offset re-use (e.g., multiple APs 108 can use the same raster interval to transmit preambles or headers).
- an offset re-use of 7 or 21 could yield the same or similar false alarm reduction performance as an arbitrarily large N in which unique raster offsets are used.
- some APs 108 may be assigned optional data packet transmit times other than or in addition to the assigned raster offset. For example, if an AP 108 raster start time has just passed, the AP 108 may still transmit a preamble or header (or data packet) during the next raster interval (subject to an exception criterion). The exception criterion may limit such exceptions so that most preamble or header transmission are aligned to the assigned raster offset (e.g., occur during the assigned raster interval).
- Non-offset aligning may result in one or more STAs 110 missing packet transmissions due to preamble or header transmission overlaps. If the relative frequency of non-offset aligned preamble or header transmissions is low compared to the total packet transmission, however, the impact on overall system false alarm reduction performance may be minimized.
- an exception criterion may be the minimum run length of offset aligned transmissions between exceptions. In particular, a run-length of 9 data packets would ensure at most one non-offset aligned preamble or header transmission every transmission of 10 data packets during an assigned raster interval.
- an exception criterion may define that an AP 108 is allowed to start transmission of a preamble or header during the assigned raster interval with probability 1 and within any other raster interval with probability p.
- a random coin toss event e.g., a random number generator
- the probabilistic approach may ensure exceptions are uniformly distributed and the value of p may allow the fraction of non-offset aligned transmissions to be controlled.
- some APs 108 may be assigned raster intervals or offsets (e.g., by the AP controller 106 ) if the APs 108 have active queues of data packets to be scheduled. This may be a form a dynamic raster interval re-use, with the number of raster offsets N and the offset assignments being reconfigured depending on the active APs 108 (e.g., the APs 108 having active queues of data packets to be scheduled). In an extreme case of only one active AP 108 , the raster may offset N may equal 1 and the AP controller 106 may assign a single offset.
- the AP 108 could start preamble or header transmission on any raster interval T r .
- An alternative to semi-static reassignment of the offsets is to extend the probabilistic approach described above without changing the set of raster offsets N.
- an AP can start transmission at the assigned offset with probability 1.
- the start probability may be q, and for all other offsets with other active APs 108 , the start probability may be p.
- the relative probabilities q>p may bias transmissions to idle AP 108 offsets versus known active AP 108 offsets.
- the STA 110 ACK and/or NAK which is directed to the serving AP 108 , may also be decoded by other STAs 110 . If the ACK and/or NAK decode processing happens to overlap with the preamble of a transmission directed to the STA 110 , a missed packet can result.
- FIG. 15 illustrates a timeline of ACK and/or NAK transmission that may reduce the likelihood that ACK and/or NAK transmissions result in missed AP 108 preambles.
- STAs 110 may be configured to start transmission of an ACK or NAK at least a hold time T h after the start of the raster interval and/or after the start of a transmission of a preamble or header 1502 .
- the STAs 110 may detect the preamble or header first and before the ACK and/or NAK.
- the STAs 110 may be configured such that transmission of the ACK and/or NAK may be complete with sufficient setup time T s , before the next raster start time (e.g., before the start of the next raster interval), such as the next time an AP 108 is eligible to transmit a header 1504 .
- the STAs 110 may be in a search state at the start of a raster interval and ready to detect any preambles or headers 1504 transmitted by an AP 108 after the current raster interval.
- the raster interval duration may be at least equal to the ACK and/or NAK transmission time, T a , plus the setup time T s and hold T h time.
- the STAs 110 may be configured to follow the following transmission settings:
- T x may be adjusted by the AP controller 106 and/or the APs 108 to ensure that the false alarm likelihood is reduced.
- the time T x may be a function of the transmission MCS, number packets, etc.
- an AP controller 106 and/or an AP 108 can pad the transmission and extend the time T x to ensure that the false alarm likelihood is reduced. As described herein, if the above-described transmission settings can be met, the likelihood of false alarms may be greatly reduced.
- data packets transmitted by a serving AP 108 that have been successfully decoded by a STA 110 may still be retransmitted by the serving AP 108 if the confirmation ACK transmitted by the STA 110 is not successfully decoded by the serving AP 108 .
- the ACK transmitted by a STA 110 may be missed by the receiving AP 108 if the receiving AP 108 is processing a preamble transmitted by another AP 108 at the time that the ACK is transmitted.
- the AP 108 may begin searching for a preamble of an ACK and/or NAK after the data packet transmission is complete.
- the AP 108 is configured to delay starting the search for a preamble of an ACK and/or NAK, such as by at least the preamble hold time T h (e.g., at least a hold time T h after the start of the raster interval and/or after the start of a transmission of a preamble or header of a data packet), any preambles transmitted by other APs 108 may be missed, thereby avoiding a false detection that could overlap with the ACK and/or NAK detection.
- the ACK time e.g., the ACK transmission time
- T a can be the total time from the end of the data packet transmission to the end of the ACK transmission.
- the AP controller 106 may assign raster offsets or intervals or otherwise assign settings or parameters for APs 108 and/or STAs 110 that govern AP 108 and/or STA 110 transmissions and/or timing.
- Disjunctive language such as the phrase “at least one of X, Y, Z,” unless specifically stated otherwise, is otherwise understood with the context as used in general to present that an item, term, etc., may be either X, Y, or Z, or any combination thereof (e.g., X, Y, and/or Z). Thus, such disjunctive language is not generally intended to, and should not, imply that certain embodiments require at least one of X, at least one of Y, or at least one of Z to each be present.
- a device configured to are intended to include one or more recited devices. Such one or more recited devices can also be collectively configured to carry out the stated recitations.
- a processor configured to carry out recitations A, B and C can include a first processor configured to carry out recitation A working in conjunction with a second processor configured to carry out recitations B and C.
- Coupled refers to two or more elements that may be either directly coupled to each other, or coupled by way of one or more intermediate elements.
- connection refers to two or more elements that may be either directly connected, or connected by way of one or more intermediate elements.
- determining may include calculating, computing, processing, deriving, generating, obtaining, looking up (e.g., looking up in a table, a database or another data structure), ascertaining and the like via a hardware element without user intervention.
- determining may include receiving (e.g., receiving information), accessing (e.g., accessing data in a memory) and the like via a hardware element without user intervention.
- determining may include resolving, selecting, choosing, establishing, and the like via a hardware element without user intervention.
- the terms “provide” or “providing” encompass a wide variety of actions.
- “providing” may include storing a value in a location of a storage device for subsequent retrieval, transmitting a value directly to the recipient via at least one wired or wireless communication medium, transmitting or storing a reference to a value, and the like.
- “Providing” may also include encoding, decoding, encrypting, decrypting, validating, verifying, and the like via a hardware element.
- a message encompasses a wide variety of formats for communicating (e.g., transmitting or receiving) information.
- a message may include a machine readable aggregation of information such as an XML document, fixed field message, comma separated message, or the like.
- a message may, in some implementations, include a signal utilized to transmit one or more representations of the information. While recited in the singular, it will be understood that a message may be composed, transmitted, stored, received, etc. in multiple parts.
- a “user interface” may refer to a network based interface including data fields and/or other controls for receiving input signals or providing electronic information and/or for providing information to the user in response to any received input signals.
- a UI may be implemented in whole or in part using technologies such as hyper-text mark-up language (HTML), Flash, Java, .net, web services, and rich site summary (RSS).
- HTTP hyper-text mark-up language
- Flash Flash
- Java Java
- .net web services
- RSS rich site summary
- a UI may be included in a stand-alone client (for example, thick client, fat client) configured to communicate (e.g., send or receive data) in accordance with one or more of the aspects described.
- a “transmit-receive point” (which can alternatively be referred to as a transmission reception point) may refer to a transceiver device or one transceiver element included in a device.
- the device When included as a transceiver element, the device may include multiple TRPs.
- the TRP may include one or more antennas which are coupled to signal processing circuitry.
- the signal processing circuitry may be included in the device.
- the TRP may include additional elements to facilitate transmission or receipt of wireless signals for one or more UEs. Example of such elements may include a power source, amplifier, digital-to-analog converter, analog-to-digital converter, or the like.
- the TRP When a TRP is allocated, such as by a BBU, to provide service to a UE, the TRP may be said to be a “serving node” for the UE.
- a “remote radio unit” may refer to a device for controlling and coordinating transmission and receipt of wireless signals for one or more UEs.
- An RRU may include or be coupled with one or more TRPs.
- the RRU may receive signals from the TRP and include the signal processing circuitry.
- the signal processing circuitry may be selectively operated to facilitate processing of signals associated with different TRPs.
- circuit blocks and/or method blocks described herein may be deleted, moved, added, subdivided, combined, arranged in a different order, and/or modified. Each of these blocks may be implemented in a variety of different ways. Any portion of any of the methods disclosed herein can be performed in association with specific instructions stored on a non-transitory computer readable storage medium being executed by one or more processors.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
- Signal Processing (AREA)
- Computer Security & Cryptography (AREA)
- Quality & Reliability (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Electromagnetism (AREA)
- Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)
Abstract
Description
- This application claims the benefit of priority to U.S. Patent Provisional Application No. 63/010,500, entitled “MULTIPOINT ASSOCIATION AND DIVERSITY” and filed on Apr. 15, 2020, which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. Any and all applications for which a foreign or domestic priority claim is identified in the Application Data Sheet as filed with the present application, are hereby incorporated by reference under 37 CFR 1.57.
- Embodiments of this disclosure relate to wireless communication systems, such as multiple-input multiple output wireless communication systems.
- The types of modern computing devices continues to increase along with the differing and dynamic needs of each device. The wireless communication systems providing services to such devices are facing increasing constraints on resources and demands for quality and quantities of service. Accordingly, improvements in providing wireless communication services, such as in a multiple-input multiple-output system, are desired.
- One aspect of the disclosure provides a wireless communication device comprising an antenna. The wireless communication device further comprises a processor in communication with the antenna, where the computer-executable instructions, when executed by the processor, cause the wireless communication device to: decode a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a second wireless communication device; determine that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet does not match an address of the wireless communication device; and begin to search for a new packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device or a third wireless communication device before transmission of the first packet is complete.
- The wireless communication device of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to transmit to the second wireless communication device information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm; where the information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm comprises a received power level of the first packet; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: process a minimum receive sensitivity level received from the second wireless communication device, and ignore any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to determine a minimum receive sensitivity level based on at least one of a received power level of the first packet or received power levels of one or more other packets detected by the wireless communication device that had a destination address that did not match the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: transmit a second packet to the second wireless communication device, and determine that the second wireless communication device did not receive the second packet; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to determine a minimum receive sensitivity level for the second wireless communication device based at least on one of a transmission power level of the second packet or an estimate of a path loss between the wireless communication device and the second wireless communication device; where the minimum receive sensitivity level is at most a level below the transmission power level of the second packet; where an access point controller is configured to select a third wireless communication device to transmit the second packet to the second wireless communication device in response to a transmission of the second packet by the wireless communication device failing; where the third wireless communication device is located at a position spatially different than a position of the wireless communication device; where the wireless communication device and the third wireless communication device are both configured to transmit data to the second wireless communication device using a same wireless protocol stack; where the access point controller pre-caches the second packet at the third wireless communication device prior to a transmission of the second packet by the wireless communication device; where a third wireless communication device retransmits the second packet to the second wireless communication device after an initial transmission of the second packet by the wireless communication device fails; where the third wireless communication device causes a scheduler to receive a beam visibility report indicating that the third wireless communication device is transmitting data to the second wireless communication device instead of the wireless communication device, where the scheduler schedules a third packet intended for the second wireless communication device to be transmitted by the third wireless communication device instead of the wireless communication device in response to receipt of the beam visibility report; where the address of the wireless communication device comprises a wildcard address; where the first portion of the first packet comprises one of a header of the first packet or a preamble of the first packet; where the wireless communication device is one of a station or an access point; where the second wireless communication device is one of an access point or a station; and where the second wireless communication device transmits the first packet during an unassigned raster interval.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides a computer-implemented method comprising: decoding a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a second wireless communication device; determining that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet does not match an address of the wireless communication device; and begin searching for a new packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device or a third wireless communication device before transmission of the first packet is complete.
- The computer-implemented method of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-implemented method further comprises: transmitting to the second wireless communication device information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm, receiving a minimum receive sensitivity level from the second wireless communication device, and ignoring any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides a wireless computing device comprising an antenna. The wireless computing device further comprises a processor in communication with the antenna, where the computer-executable instructions, when executed by the processor, cause the wireless computing device to: authenticate with one or more access points; decode a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a first access point in the one or more access points; determine that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address of the wireless computing device; and process the first packet in response to the determination that the destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the wireless computing device, irrespective of a source address included in the first portion of the first packet.
- The wireless computing device of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: decode a first portion of a second packet transmitted by the first access point, determine that a destination address included in the first portion of the second packet does not match an address of the wireless computing device, and begin to search for a new packet transmitted by any access point in the one or more access points before transmission of the second packet is complete; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to transmit to the first access point information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm; where the information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm comprises a received power level of the second packet; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to: process a minimum receive sensitivity level received from the first access point, and ignore any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to determine a minimum receive sensitivity level based on at least one of a received power level of the second packet or received power levels of one or more other packets detected by the wireless communication device that had a destination address that did not match the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the wireless communication device to decode a first portion of a second packet transmitted by a second access point in the one or more access points, where the second access point transmits the second packet in response to a transmission of the second packet by the first access point failing; where the second access point is located at a position spatially different than a position of the first access point; where the first access point and the second access point are both configured to transmit data to the wireless communication device using a same wireless protocol stack; where an access point controller pre-caches the second packet at the second access point device prior to a transmission of the second packet by the first access point; where the second access point causes a scheduler to receive a beam visibility report indicating that the second access point is transmitting data to the wireless communication device instead of the first access point, where the scheduler schedules a third packet intended for the wireless communication device to be transmitted by the second access point instead of the first access point in response to receipt of the beam visibility report; where the first portion of the first packet comprises one of a header of the first packet or a preamble of the first packet; where the wireless communication device is a station; and where the first access point transmits the first packet during an unassigned raster interval.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides computer-implemented method comprising: authenticating, by a wireless computing device, with one or more access points; decoding a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a first access point in the one or more access points; determining that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address of the wireless computing device; and processing the first packet in response to the determination that the destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the wireless computing device, irrespective of a source address included in the first portion of the first packet.
- The computer-implemented method of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-implemented method further comprises: decoding a first portion of a second packet transmitted by the first access point, determining that a destination address included in the first portion of the second packet does not match an address of the wireless computing device, and begin searching for a new packet transmitted by any access point in the one or more access points before transmission of the second packet is complete; where the computer-implemented method further comprises: transmitting to the first access point information identifying an occurrence of a false alarm, receiving a minimum receive sensitivity level from the first access point, and ignoring any transmitted packets that have a received power level below the minimum receive sensitivity level; where the computer-implemented method further comprises determining a minimum receive sensitivity level based on at least one of a received power level of the second packet or received power levels of one or more other packets detected by the wireless communication device that had a destination address that did not match the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-implemented method further comprises decoding a first portion of a second packet transmitted by a second access point in the one or more access points, where the second access point transmits the second packet in response to a transmission of the second packet by the first access point failing; where the second access point is located at a position spatially different than a position of the first access point; and where the first access point and the second access point are both configured to transmit data to the wireless communication device using a same wireless protocol stack.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides an access point comprising an antenna. The access point further comprises a processor in communication with the antenna, where the computer-executable instructions, when executed by the processor, cause the access point to: authenticate a wireless communication device; decode a first portion of a first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device; determine that an address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address associated with the wireless communication device; and process the first packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device, irrespective of whether the first packet includes an address of the access point.
- The access point of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to process the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the wireless communication device is authenticated and the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device; where the address included in the first portion of the first packet is a source address in a header of the first packet; where the first portion of the first packet includes a wildcard address associated with the access point; where the address associated with the wireless communication device is an address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to process the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet is a source address that matches the address of the wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to process the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet is a source address that matches an address of an authenticated wireless communication device; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to: transmit a second packet to the wireless communication device, and determine that the wireless communication device did not receive the second packet; where the computer-executable instructions, when executed, further cause the access point to determine a minimum receive sensitivity level for the wireless communication device based at least on one of a transmission power level of the second packet or an estimate of a path loss between the access point and the wireless communication device; where the minimum receive sensitivity level is at most a level below the transmission power level of the second packet; where an access point controller is configured to select a second access point to transmit the second packet to the wireless communication device in response to a transmission of the second packet by the access point failing; where the second access point is located at a position spatially different than a position of the access point; where the access point and the second access point are both configured to transmit data to the wireless communication device using a same wireless protocol stack; where the access point controller pre-caches the second packet at the second access point prior to a transmission of the second packet by the access point; where a second access point retransmits the second packet to the wireless communication device after an initial transmission of the second packet by the access point fails; where the second access point causes a scheduler to receive a beam visibility report indicating that the second access point is transmitting data to the wireless communication device instead of the access point, where the scheduler schedules a third packet intended for the wireless communication device to be transmitted by the second access point instead of the access point in response to receipt of the beam visibility report; where the first portion of the first packet comprises one of a header of the first packet or a preamble of the first packet; and where the wireless communication device is a station.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides computer-implemented method comprising: authenticating, by an access point, a wireless communication device; decoding a first portion of a first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device; determining that an address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address associated with the wireless communication device; and processing the first packet transmitted by the second wireless communication device in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device, irrespective of whether the first packet includes an address of the access point.
- The computer-implemented method of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where processing the first packet further comprises processing the first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device in response to a determination that the wireless communication device is authenticated and the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless communication device.
- Another aspect of the disclosure provides a wireless communication system comprising a plurality of access points, where the access point transmission timelines are synchronized, and where each access point transmission start time aligns to a raster interval.
- The wireless communication system of the preceding paragraph can include any sub-combination of the following features: where access point transmission start times are offset to a plurality of other access point start times; where access point offsets are assigned according to a re-use pattern; where access point transmission start times include at least one start time that is not an assigned offset; where the non-offset aligned start times are controlled probabilistically; where the offset re-use assignment is dynamically reconfigured in response to changes in the active access points; and where access point transmission times are adjusted to ensure that station acknowledgement or negative acknowledgement message lags the preamble, and that the station acknowledgement or negative acknowledgement message leads the raster start times.
- Embodiments of this disclosure will now be described, by way of non-limiting example, with reference to the accompanying drawings.
-
FIG. 1A is a diagram of a multipoint environment in which multiple stations and access points can communicate with each other according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 1B is a schematic diagram illustrating a wireless network that includes the baseband unit according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 2 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 3 is another block diagram of the multipoint environment ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 4 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA using false alarm information according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 5 is a block diagram of the multipoint environment ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for a STA using missed detect information according to an embodiment. -
FIGS. 6A-6B are block diagrams of the multipoint environment ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of the multipoint environment to pre-cache data packets according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 7 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine illustratively implemented by a STA and/or an AP, according to one embodiment. -
FIG. 8 is a flow diagram depicting a minimum Rx sensitivity selection routine illustratively implemented by an AP, an AP controller, and/or a STA according to one embodiment. -
FIG. 9 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine illustratively implemented by a STA, according to one embodiment. -
FIG. 10 is a flow diagram depicting a packet detection routine illustratively implemented by an AP, according to one embodiment. -
FIG. 11 is a block diagram illustrating an example baseband unit and remote radio unit according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example STA according to an embodiment. -
FIG. 13 illustrates an example timeline for packet transmissions from an AP to a STA, depicting reasons why a data packet transmission miss may occur. -
FIG. 14 illustrates a synchronized system in which AP packet transmission times are synchronized to a raster. -
FIG. 15 illustrates a timeline of ACK and/or NAK transmission that may reduce the likelihood that ACK and/or NAK transmissions result in missed AP preambles. - The following description of certain embodiments presents various descriptions of specific embodiments. However, the innovations described herein can be embodied in a multitude of different ways, for example, as defined and covered by the claims. In this description, reference is made to the drawings where like reference numerals can indicate identical or functionally similar elements. It will be understood that elements illustrated in the figures are not necessarily drawn to scale. Moreover, it will be understood that certain embodiments can include more elements than illustrated in a drawing and/or a subset of the elements illustrated in a drawing. Further, some embodiments can incorporate any suitable combination of features from two or more drawings. The headings provided herein are for convenience only and do not necessarily affect the scope or meaning of the claims.
- As wireless networks are increasingly used to run services sensitive to reliability and/or latency issues (e.g., media streaming, video chat, virtual reality, augmented reality, etc.), any situations that negatively affect reliability and/or latency can be problematic. For example, a station (STA) typically decodes a packet and analyzes a destination address and source address included in the header of the packet to determine whether the packet is intended for the STA. Access points (APs) perform a similar operation. Decoding a packet and analyzing the destination address and the source address, however, can increase a time that it takes a STA or AP to process a received packet.
- In fact, false alarms often occur in which a STA or AP locks onto a transmitted packet that is not intended for the STA or AP. For example, a STA or AP may detect that transmission of a packet is occurring and attempting to decode the packet. The STA or AP may eventually determine that the packet is not meant for the STA or AP (e.g., based on an analysis of the destination address and source address in the header of the packet). The STA or AP, however, typically remains locked onto the packet until transmission of the packet is complete, even after determining that the packet is not meant for the STA or AP (where the determination generally occurs before transmission of the packet is complete). In other words, if a typical STA or AP detects the transmission of a first packet, the STA or AP does not start searching for a new packet until transmission of the first packet is complete whether or not the first packet is actually intended for the STA or AP. If a packet that is actually intended for the STA or AP is transmitted or begins to be transmitted before transmission of a packet locked onto by and not intended for the STA or AP is complete, then the STA or AP may not receive or process the packet that is actually intended for the STA or AP. Thus, false alarms can increase the latency of the wireless network in situations in which a STA or AP locks onto a packet not intended for the STA or AP, and can reduce the reliability of the wireless network in situations in which the STA or AP misses a packet intended for the STA or AP because the STA or AP was locked onto another packet not intended for the STA or AP.
- In addition, obstructions and/or interference can prevent a STA from receiving a transmission from an AP, and vice-versa. Typically, a STA or AP may retransmit a packet if an initial transmission fails (e.g., if the AP or STA for which the packet is intended does not receive the packet, as indicated by the failure of the AP or STA to send an acknowledgement message acknowledging receipt of the packet). However, if the initial transmission failed because of an obstruction (e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.) and/or interference (e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP or STA), the obstruction and/or interference is likely to still be present when the STA or AP attempts the retransmission (e.g., given that retransmissions generally occur within 1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, etc. of the initial transmission). Thus, obstructions and/or interference can also reduce the reliability of the wireless network.
- To increase the reliability and reduce the latency of the wireless network, described herein is a multipoint environment that enables a STA to communicate with multiple APs and an AP to communicate with multiple STAs in a single wireless protocol stack (e.g., a single IEEE 802.11 protocol stack). For example, a STA can authenticate simultaneously with multiple APs and decode any data packet that includes in a header a destination address that matches an address of the STA, irrespective of the source address included in the header of the data packet. Similarly, an AP can decode any data packet that includes in a header a destination address that matches an address of the AP or that matches a wildcard address associated with the AP, irrespective of the source address included in the header of the data packet.
- Thus, unlike typical wireless network environments in which a basic service set (BSS) includes one AP assigned to one or more STAs, the multipoint environment described herein has no pre-defined AP to which a STA is associated. Rather, the AP transmitting a data packet to a particular STA can change on a packet-by-packet basis. For example, a first AP can transmit a first data packet to a STA at a first time, a second AP can transmit a second data packet to the STA at a second time, a third AP can transmit a third data packet to the STA at a third time, the first AP can transmit a fourth data packet to the STA at a fourth time, and so on. In fact, the AP that transmits a data packet to the STA can change without the STA changing BSSs to which the STA is associated—the STA may remain in the same BSS using the same, single wireless stack while the AP that transmits data packets to the STA changes. Similarly, there may be no pre-defined STA to which an AP is associated. Rather, the STA transmitting a data packet to a particular AP can change on a packet-by-packet basis.
- The multipoint environment can further include an AP controller (also referred to herein as a central controller) that can select the AP to transmit a data packet to a STA. For example, the AP controller can route traffic to one or more APs for transmission to one or more STAs based on downlink and/or uplink quality measurements.
- To minimize the negative effects of false alarms, the STAs and APs in the multipoint environment can each be configured to restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP, use a minimum receive (Rx) sensitivity level below which the STA or AP does not attempt to decode the header of a data packet, or both restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP and use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to decode the header of a data packet. For example, instead of locking onto a data packet until transmission of the data packet is complete (e.g., transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the data packet is complete), a STA or AP can decode the header of a detected data packet to determine whether the destination address included in the header matches an address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP. If the destination address does not produce a match (indicating that the data packet is not intended for the STA or AP), then the STA or AP can start searching for a new data packet without waiting for transmission of the initial data packet to finish. In particular, the STA or AP can start a physical (PHY) clear channel assessment (CCA) and short training field (STF) detection procedure to detect transmissions of data packets (e.g., to begin detecting the transmission of a preamble, header, and/or data payload of a data packet). Upon detecting the transmission of a preamble or header of a data packet using the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure, the STA or AP can decode the destination address included in the preamble or header. If the destination address does not match the address (or wildcard address) of the STA or AP, then the STA or AP can restart the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to detect the transmission of another packet, even before transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet is complete.
- Alternatively or in addition, a STA can provide to an AP information identifying a false alarm when the STA attempts to decode a data packet only to find that the destination address of the data packet does not match the address of the STA. The AP can gather information for one or more false alarms identified by the STA, and use this information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA. For example, the AP can determine the mean, median, mode, etc. of the received power level of the data packets that the STA identified as resulting in a false alarm, and the AP can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA to be some level above the mean, median, mode, etc. of the received power level of the data packets that the STA identified as resulting in a false alarm. Alternatively or in addition, the AP can gather information for one or more missed detects (e.g., data packet transmissions intended for the STA that were not received by the STA) and use this information alone or with the false alarm information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for the STA. For example, the AP can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be some level below the mean, median, mode, etc. of the transmission power level of the data packets intended for the STA that were not received by the STA (or the power level at which the data packets should have been received by the STA) minus the estimate of the path loss from the AP to the STA. The AP can then provide the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to the STA so that the STA can begin using the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet. Similarly, an AP can use missed detect information obtained from a STA (e.g., information identifying data packets intended for the AP that were not received by the AP) and/or false alarm information determined by the AP (e.g., information associated with data packets decoded by the AP that were not intended for the AP) to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for itself in a similar manner. The AP can then use the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet.
- By configuring a STA or AP to restart the data packet detection procedure soon after identifying that a destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of a STA or AP and/or to use a minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet, the multipoint environment increases the reliability and reduces the latency of a wireless network. For example, reliability may be increased because an STA or AP is less likely to miss a data packet intended for the STA or AP given that the STA or AP is no longer waiting for transmission of a data packet to finish before searching for a new data packet. Latency of the wireless network may be reduced because a STA or AP may no longer decode all detected data packets. Rather, the STA or AP may only decode those data packets that have a received power level over a minimum Rx sensitivity level, which may cause the STA or AP to decode sooner those data packets actually intended for the STA or AP.
- The AP controller may further increase reliability and reduce latency in the wireless network by implementing retransmission diversity. For example, transmission of a data packet from an AP to a STA or from a STA to an AP may fail due to an obstruction (e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.) and/or interference (e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP or STA) being present. Generally, the data packet may be retransmitted in response to the initial transmission failure. Retransmitting the data packet from the same STA or AP is likely to result in another transmission failure, however, because retransmissions generally occur soon after the initial transmission (e.g., 1 ms after, 10 ms after, 100 ms after, etc.) and the obstruction and/or interference is still likely to be present given the short timeframe between transmissions. Thus, in the event of a data packet transmission failure, the AP controller can trigger a retransmission of the data packet from another STA or AP, such as from a STA or AP that has a different spatial location than the STA or AP that originally transmitted the data packet. Accordingly, the retransmission is less likely to be affected by the obstruction and/or interference, and the recipient STA or AP is then more likely to receive the retransmitted data packet.
- In addition, the AP controller can pre-cache a data packet at one or more APs, even before the AP that is originally assigned to transmit the data packet transmits the data packet. For example, there may be a time delay involved in an AP controller transmitting a data packet to an AP so that the AP can transmit the data packet to a STA. Pre-caching the data packet at multiple APs before the data packet is transmitted by any AP (and therefore before a transmission failure occurs) may reduce the time it takes for a second AP to retransmit the data packet if the first transmission of the data packet fails. Thus, if the transmission by a first AP that is originally assigned to transmit the data packet fails, the AP controller can instruct a second AP at which the data packet has already been pre-cached to transmit the data packet. The time waiting for the second AP to receive the data packet from the AP controller is therefore eliminated. Thus, the time from when the AP controller determines that the second AP should retransmit the data packet to when the second AP retransmits the data packet is reduced, thereby reducing the latency involved with retransmitting the data packet.
- In an embodiment, the multipoint environment described herein is designed to operate at higher frequencies, such as at millimeter wave (mmW) frequencies, such as between 24 GHz to 300 GHz. In general, mmW frequencies can encompass at least some frequency ranges between 2 GHz to 3 GHz, at least some frequency ranges in the Super high frequency (SHF) bands (e.g., 3 GHz to 30 GHz), and/or at least some frequency ranges in the Extremely High Frequency (EHF) bands (e.g., 30 GHz to 300 GHz). The techniques described herein can be applied to networks operating at any suitable range of frequencies. In addition, the techniques described herein can be used for a variety of use cases, such as media streaming, video chat, virtual reality, augmented reality, etc.
-
FIG. 1A is a diagram of amultipoint environment 100 in whichmultiple STAs 110A-D andAPs 108A-I can communicate with each other according to an embodiment. As illustrated inFIG. 1A , themultipoint environment 100 includes a plurality ofAPs 108A-I, a plurality ofSTAs 110A-D, anAP controller 106, and abaseband unit 140. In an embodiment, data packets can be wirelessly transmitted from thebaseband unit 140 to the plurality ofSTAs 110A-D via one or more of theAPs 108A-I. Similarly, data packets can be transmitted from the plurality ofSTAs 110A-D to one ormore APs 108A-I. - As described herein, a
STA 110A-D can communicate withmultiple APs 108A-I and anAP 108A-I can communicate withmultiple STAs 110A-D in a single wireless stack (e.g., a single IEEE 820.11 protocol stack). For example, aSTA 110A-D can authenticate simultaneously withmultiple APs 108A-I (e.g., one or more of theAPs 108A-I can individual or collectively authenticate theSTA 110A-D upon request from theSTA 110A-D) and decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of theSTA 110A-D, irrespective of the source address included in the header or preamble of the data packet (e.g., theSTA 110A-D can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of theSTA 110A-D whether or not the source address is the address of aparticular AP 108A-I). Similarly, anAP 108A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of theAP 108A-I or that matches a wildcard address associated with theAP 108A-I, irrespective of the source address included in the header of the data packet (e.g., theAP 108A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a destination address that matches an address of theAP 108A-I or that matches a wildcard address associated with theAP 108A-I whether or not the source address is the address of aparticular STA 110A-D). For example, a wildcard address may be an address associated with multiple APs 108A-I rather than a unique address associated with just one AP 108A-I. As one illustrative example, the address associated with multiple APs 108A-I could be one or more addresses of one or more STAs 110A-D that has authenticated with some or all of the APs 108A-I. Thus, the wildcard address can be one or more addresses of one or more authenticated STAs 110A-D. As another example, an AP 108A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a source address that matches an address of one of a set of STAs 110A-D, such as an address of a STA 110A-D that has already authenticated with the AP 108A-I or another AP 108A-I that is part of the same wireless protocol stack as the AP 108A-I, irrespective of whether the destination address in the header or preamble matches an address of the AP 108A-I (e.g., the AP 108A-I can decode any data packet that includes in a header or preamble a source address that matches an address of one of a set of STAs 110A-D that has already authenticated with the AP 108A-I or another AP 108A-I that is part of the same wireless protocol stack whether or not the destination address is the address of the AP 108A-I itself). - For the purposes of illustration and not meant to be limiting,
STA 110A communicates withAPs STA 110B communicates withAPs STA 110C communicates withAPs STA 110D communicates withAPs STAs 110A-D andAPs 108A-I, however, can communicate withother APs 108A-I andSTAs 110A-D. Thus, unlike typical wireless network environments in which a BSS includes one AP assigned to one or more STAs, themultipoint environment 100 has nopre-defined AP 108A-I to which aSTA 110A-D is associated. Rather, theAP 108A-I transmitting a data packet to aparticular STA 110A-D can change on a packet-by-packet basis. For example, theAP 108D can transmit a first data packet to theSTA 110C at a first time, theAP 108E can transmit a second data packet to theSTA 110C at a second time, theAP 108H can transmit a third data packet to theSTA 110C at a third time, theAP 108D can transmit a fourth data packet to theSTA 110C at a fourth time, and so on. In fact, theAP 108A-I that transmits a data packet to theSTA 110A-D can change without theSTA 110A-D changing BSSs to which theSTA 110A-D is associated—theSTA 110A-D may remain in the same BSS using the same, single wireless stack while theAP 108A-I that transmits data packets to theSTA 110A-D changes. Similarly, there may be nopre-defined STA 110A-D to which anAP 108A-I is associated. Rather, theSTA 110A-D transmitting a data packet to aparticular AP 108A-I can change on a packet-by-packet basis. - The
AP controller 106 can be configured to select theAP 108A-I to transmit a data packet to aSTA 110A-D. For example, theAP controller 106 can route traffic to one ormore APs 108A-I for transmission to one or more STAs 110A-D based on downlink and/or uplink quality measurements. A downlink (DL) transmission generally refers to a communication from a network system (e.g., an AP) to a user terminal (e.g., a STA). An uplink (UL) transmission generally refers to a communication from the user terminal to the network system. - In the
multipoint environment 100, base station functionality is subdivided between thebaseband unit 140, theAP controller 106, and/or multiple remote radio units (RRUs) (e.g.,APs 108A-I). An RRU may include multiple antennas, and one or more of the antennas may serve as a transmit-receive point (TRP). The RRU and/or a TRP may be referred to as a serving node, a base station, or an access point. Thebaseband unit 140 may be physically connected to theAP controller 106 and/or the RRUs, such as via an optical fiber connection. Thebaseband unit 140 and/or theAP controller 106 may provide operational details to an RRU to control transmission and reception of signals from the RRU along with control data and payload data to transmit. The RRU may provide data to the network received fromSTAs 110A-D within a service area associated with the RRU. An RRU can provide service to devices (e.g.,STAs 110A-D) within a service area. For example, wireless downlink transmission service may be provided by an RRU to the service area to communicate data to one or more devices within the service area. - The
APs 108A-I may each have one or more transmit antennas that each support one or more digital basebands. In some embodiments, eachAP 108A-I has the same number of transmit antennas. In other embodiments, some or all APs 108 a-I have a different number of transmit antennas thanother APs 108A-I. Thus, theAPs 108A-I may collectively be capable of transmitting N spatial beams, where N is the product of the number ofAPs 108A-I in themultipoint environment 100 and the number of transmit antennas operated by asingle AP 108A-I. Similarly, eachAP 108A-I can have the same number or different number of receive antennas. Thebaseband unit 140, theAP controller 106, and/or theAPs 108A-I can be collectively referred to herein as a “network system.” - Various standards and protocols may be included in the
multipoint environment 100 to wirelessly communicate data between a base station (e.g., an AP 108) and a wireless communication device (e.g., a STA 110). Some wireless devices may communicate using an orthogonal frequency-division multiplexing (OFDM) digital modulation scheme via a physical layer. OFDM standards and protocols can include the third generation partnership project (3GPP) long term evolution (LTE), the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) 802.16 standard (e.g., 802.16e, 802.16m), which may be known as WiMAX (Worldwide interoperability for Microwave Access), and the IEEE 802.11 standard, which may be known as Wi-Fi. In some systems, a radio access network (RAN) may include one or more base stations associated with one or more evolved NodeBs (also commonly denoted as enhanced NodeBs, eNodeBs, or eNBs), next generation NodeBs (gNBs), or any other suitable NodeBs (xNBs). In other embodiments, radio network controllers (RNCs) may be provided as the base stations. A base station provides a bridge between the wireless network and a core network such as the Internet. The base station may be included to facilitate exchange of data for the wireless communication devices of the wireless network. - The wireless communication device may be referred to as a station (STA) (e.g., for wireless communication devices that communicate using the IEEE 802.11 standard). The wireless communication device may also be referred to as a UE (e.g., for wireless communication devices that communicate in a RAN). The STA may be a device used by a user such as a smartphone, a laptop, a tablet computer, cellular telephone, a wearable computing device such as smart glasses or a smart watch or an ear piece, one or more networked appliances (e.g., consumer networked appliances or industrial plant equipment), an industrial robot with connectivity, or a vehicle. In some implementations, the STA may include a sensor or other networked device configured to collect data and wirelessly provide the data to a device (e.g., server) connected to a core network such as the Internet. Such devices may be referred to as Internet of Things devices (IoT devices).
- The
AP controller 106 can function as a router to route traffic between thebaseband unit 140 and theAPs 108A-I. TheAP controller 106 can implement a relatively small amount of buffering. This can contribute to theAP controller 106 routing data between thebaseband unit 140 and theAPs 108A-I with low latency. TheAP controller 106 can include any suitable hardware to implement the functionality described herein. - The
APs 108A-I can be arranged as an array. All of theAPs 108A-I can be connected to theAP controller 106. TheAPs 108A-I can be connected to theAP controller 106 via wired or wireless connections. EachAP 108A-I can buffer a relatively low amount of frames of data at a time. For example, anAP 108A can buffer 1 or 2 frames of data at a time in certain applications. The frames can be relatively big frames. For example, one frame can include 100 to 150 Internet protocol (IP) packets. TheAPs 108A-I are arranged to wirelessly communicate withSTAs 110A-D. TheAPs 108A-I can communicate via any suitable wireless links, such as wireless local area network (WLAN) links. WLAN signals can have a shorter signal range than cellular signals. In some instances, the WLAN signals can have a range of about 300 feet or less. WLAN signals can have a range of about 150 feet or less in certain applications. An example of a WLAN link is a Wi-Fi link. The WLAN link can be implemented based on an IEEE 802.11 standard. TheAPs 108A-I are networking hardware devices that include any suitable physical hardware to implement the functionalities disclosed herein. Although APs are described with reference to certain embodiments for illustrative purposes, any suitable principles and advantages described with references to access points can be implemented with any other suitable serving nodes of a network system. Any suitable wireless link that meets latency and throughput specifications can be used. Wi-Fi links, millimeter wave (mmW) wireless area network (WAN) links, and fifth generation (5G) New Radio (NR) links in Frequency Range 2 (FR2) are examples of such suitable wireless links. -
FIG. 1B is a schematic diagram illustrating awireless network 150 that includes thebaseband unit 140 according to an embodiment. In this embodiment, theAPs 108A-I may operate as RRUs or serving nodes, and thebaseband unit 140 and/or the AP controller 106 (not shown) may select users (e.g.,STAs 110,STA 110 receive antennas, etc.) to be served by one ormore APs 108A-I over one or more time slots and/or over one or more spatial dimensions. - As illustrated in
FIG. 1B , thebaseband unit 140 includes user data TX buffers 112, thescheduler control 114, a time/frequencyresource allocation block 116, an active set andbeam management block 118, atransceiver 120, aCSI computation block 122, an active set servingnode update block 124, and the channelstate data store 130. Thebaseband unit 140 can include any suitable physical hardware to implement the illustrated blocks. For example, thebaseband unit 140 can include a processor and computer readable storage to implement any suitable blocks shown inFIG. 1B . Thewireless network 150 also includes theAPs 108A-I, one or more STAs 110, and/or the AP controller 106 (not shown). Thewireless network 150 optionally includes other APs 108, not shown. - The
baseband unit 140 and/or theAP controller 106 includes a scheduler that selects users to serve over one or more spatial dimensions over one or more time slots, selectsAPs 108A-I to serve user data, and schedules user data for wireless transmission between theAPs 108A-I and STAs 110 over various spatial dimensions (e.g., spatial beams, channels, etc.). The scheduler can schedule DL data traffic, UL data traffic, or both. The scheduler can schedule data from any suitable number of APs 108 to any suitable number ofUEs 110. The scheduler can include the user data queue TX buffers 112, thescheduler control 114, the time/frequencyresource allocation block 116, the active set andbeam management block 118, theCSI computation block 122, the active set servingnode update block 124, and/or the channelstate data store 130. - The
transceiver 120 can provide a STA report received from theSTA 110 to the scheduler. For example, the STA report can include spatial beam link strengths, spatial beam link quality, and/or other CSI suitable for allowing the scheduler to schedule DL data transmissions and/or to schedule UL data transmissions. TheCSI computation block 122 can compute CSI data from data in the STA report. The active set servingnode update block 124 can determine an updated active set for one or more STAs 110 based on updated link strength information provided by the STA(s) 110 (e.g., provided by the STA(s) 110 in response to receiving DL data traffic). In some instances, the active set servingnode update block 124 can determine an updated active set for a subset of one or more antennas of aSTA 110. The active set servingnode update block 124 can use any suitable metrics disclosed herein to update an active set associated with aSTA 110. - The
transceiver 120 can also provide a beam visibility report received from theSTA 110 and/or AP 108 to the scheduler. The beam visibility report can indicate which AP 108 has started transmitting UL data to aSTA 110 in response to a blockage, obstruction, or other interference. For example, one AP 108 may have initially been serving aSTA 110. Due to an obstruction or interference, however, another AP 108 may start serving theSTA 110 instead. The beam visibility report can inform the scheduler of the new AP 108 that has started serving theSTA 110 instead. The scheduler (e.g., the active set serving node update block 124) can use this information to determine an updated active set for the STA 110 (e.g., update information identifying the beam(s) serving theSTA 110, which may now include the beam from the new AP 108 serving theSTA 110, such that future DL transmissions to theSTA 110 are completed using at least one of the identified beam(s)). - Alternatively or in addition, the beam visibility report can include information from a
STA 110 indicating that theSTA 110 cannot receive transmissions from a beam transmitted by an AP 108 originally assigned to serve theSTA 110, but that theSTA 110 can receive transmissions from a beam transmitted by another AP 108. The scheduler (e.g., the active set serving node update block 124) can use this information to determine an updated active set for the STA 110 (e.g., update information identifying the beam(s) serving theSTA 110, which may now include the beam from the another AP 108 that theSTA 110 can see, such that future DL transmissions to theSTA 110 are completed using at least one of the identified beam(s)). - The updated active set data is provided to the
scheduler control 114. The user data queue TX buffers 112 can provide user data (e.g., DL user data) to thescheduler control 114. Thescheduler control 114 provides user data to thetransceiver 120 and also provides instructions to the time/frequencyresource allocation block 116. The time/frequencyresource allocation block 116 can schedule timing and frequency of DL and/or UL data transmission from and/or to APs 108 (e.g., generate scheduling data), which can be forwarded to the APs 108 via thetransceiver 120 and/or theAP controller 106. This can avoid timing conflicts and conflicts in the frequency domain. The active set andbeam management block 118 can select APs 108 and/or specific spatial beams offered by these APs 108 for providing wireless transmission services toSTAs 110, and create corresponding active sets for theSTAs 110. The active set andbeam management block 118 can group DL data transmissions and manage beamforming from the APs 108 to theSTAs 110. Thetransceiver 120 provides data for transmission by the APs 108 toSTAs 110. - As illustrated in
FIG. 1B , the scheduler can cause a network system of thewireless network 150 to wirelessly transmit first user data to afirst STA 110 across one or more spatial beams or spatial dimensions, to transmit second user data to asecond STA 110 across one or more spatial beams or spatial dimensions, and so on. The scheduler can cause the transmissions of the first user data, the second user data, etc. to occur simultaneously and/or at different times. Moreover, the scheduler can cause a network system of thewireless network 150 to wirelessly transmit user data to any suitable number ofSTAs 110 across one or more spatial beams or spatial dimensions served by one or more APs 108. -
FIG. 2 is a block diagram of themultipoint environment 100 ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of themultipoint environment 100 to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment. To minimize the negative effects of false alarms, theSTAs 110 and APs 108 in themultipoint environment 100 can each be configured to restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of theSTA 110 or AP 108, use a minimum receive (Rx) sensitivity level below which theSTA 110 or AP 108 does not attempt to decode the header or preamble of a data packet, or both restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the destination address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of theSTA 110 or AP 108 and use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to decode the header or preamble of a data packet. The operations depicted inFIG. 2 are directed to the data packet detection procedure restart described herein being performed by aSTA 110. - For example, instead of locking onto a data packet until transmission of the data packet is complete (e.g., transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the data packet is complete), a
STA 110 or AP 108 can decode the header or preamble of a detected data packet to determine whether the destination address included in the header or preamble matches an address (or wildcard address) of theSTA 110 or AP 108. If the destination address in the header or preamble does not match an address (or wildcard address) of theSTA 110 or AP 108 (indicating that the data packet is not intended for theSTA 110 or AP 108), then theSTA 110 or AP 108 can start searching for a new data packet without waiting for transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet to finish. In particular, theSTA 110 or AP 108 can start a PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to detect transmissions of data packets (e.g., to begin detecting the transmission of a preamble, header, and/or data payload of a data packet). Upon detecting the transmission of a preamble or header of a data packet using the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure, theSTA 110 or AP 108 can decode the destination address included in the preamble or header. If the destination address does not match the address (or wildcard address) of theSTA 110 or AP 108, then theSTA 110 or AP 108 can restart the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to attempt to detect the transmission of another packet, even before transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet is complete. - As illustrated in
FIG. 2 , theAP 108A transmits a first portion ofpacket 202 at time T1 toSTA 110A at (1). For example, the first portion of thepacket 202 may be the header or preamble of thepacket 202. TheSTA 110A can detect the transmission and decode the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 202 at (2). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 202, theSTA 110A determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) does not match theSTA 110A address at (3). As a result, theSTA 110A begins looking for a new packet without waiting for completion of the transmission of thepacket 202 at (4). For example, theSTA 110A may begin searching for a new packet prior to the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of thepacket 202. - The
AP 108B transmits apacket 204 to theSTA 110A at time T2 at (5). The time T2 may be after the time T1, but before the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of thepacket 202. For example, theAP 108A may transmit a second portion of thepacket 202 to theSTA 110A at time T3 at (6). The time T3 may be after the time T2. The second portion of thepacket 202 may be a subsequent part of the header, a subsequent part of the preamble, and/or the data payload of thepacket 202. - The
STA 110A can decode the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 204 at (7). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 204, theSTA 110A determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) matches theSTA 110A address at (8). TheSTA 110A can then lock onto thepacket 204 and process the remaining portion of thepacket 204. - In further embodiments, the
AP controller 106, some or all of theAPs 108A-I, and/or some or all of theSTAs 110A-D can be configured to execute additional operations that further minimize false alarms. For example, an AP 108 transmission can include a header, a payload, and a guard time that follows the payload to allow theSTA 110 to transmit a positive acknowledgement (ACK) message or a negative acknowledgement (NAK) message. In one scenario, aSTA 110 begins searching for a data packet. After successfully identifying and decoding a preamble or header of a data packet that has a destination address that matches the address of theSTA 110, theSTA 110 continues to decode the payload. Once the preamble or header and/or payload are decoded, theSTA 110 can transmit an ACK or NAK to the AP 108 that transmitted the data packet and/or to another AP 108, such as another AP 108 that shares the same wireless protocol stack as the packet transmitted AP 108 as described herein. TheSTA 110 then begins searching for another data packet. - In a second scenario, a
STA 110 begins searching for a data packet. After successfully identifying and decoding a preamble or header of a data packet that has a destination address that does not match the address of theSTA 110, theSTA 110 aborts the payload decode and continues searching for a preamble or header of another data packet. - In a third scenario, a
STA 110B begins searching for a data packet. After successfully identifying and decoding an ACK and/or NAK transmitted by anotherSTA 110A, theSTA 110B finishes processing the ACK and/or NAK and continues searching for another data packet. - Pre-empting full data packet processing in a manner as described above with respect to
FIG. 2 and elsewhere in this disclosure (e.g., based on determining whether the destination address in a header or preamble matches a destination address of a receiving device, based on determining whether a source address in a header or preamble matches an address of an authenticated device, etc.) can reduce the likelihood that aSTA 110 misses a transmission from an AP 108 that is intended for theSTA 110 and that is transmitted while theSTA 110 is processing a false alarm data packet (e.g., a data packet not intended for theSTA 110, a data packet intended for anotherSTA 110, a data packet transmitted by an AP 108 with which theSTA 110 has not authenticated, etc.). However, aSTA 110 may still miss some transmissions intended for theSTA 110. For example, the header of a data packet intended for aSTA 110 may be missed if theSTA 110 is processing the header of a data packet not intended for theSTA 110. Such overlap may be possible because traditional AP 108 transmissions may not be synchronized or even temporarily coordinated.FIGS. 13-15 below describe in greater detail additional operations that can be performed by theAP controller 106, some or all of theAPs 108A-I, and/or some or all of theSTAs 110A-D to further reduce the likelihood that data packet transmissions intended for aSTA 110 are missed by theSTA 110. -
FIG. 3 is another block diagram of themultipoint environment 100 ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of themultipoint environment 100 to minimize the negative effects of false alarms according to an embodiment. The operations depicted inFIG. 3 are directed to the data packet detection procedure restart described herein being performed by an AP 108. - As illustrated in
FIG. 3 , theSTA 110A transmits a first portion ofpacket 302 at time T1 toAP 108B at (1). For example, the first portion of thepacket 302 may be the header or preamble of thepacket 302. TheAP 108B can detect the transmission and decode the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 302 at (2). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 302, theAP 108B determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) does not match theAP 108B address or the wildcard address associated with theAP 108B at (3). As a result, theAP 108B begins looking for a new packet without waiting for completion of the transmission of thepacket 302 at (4). For example, theAP 108B may begin searching for a new packet prior to the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of thepacket 302. - The
STA 110B transmits apacket 304 to theAP 108B at time T2 at (5). The time T2 may be after the time T1, but before the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of thepacket 302. For example, theSTA 110A may transmit a second portion of thepacket 302 to theAP 108B at time T3 at (6). The time T3 may be after the time T2. The second portion of thepacket 302 may be a subsequent part of the header, a subsequent part of the preamble, and/or the data payload of thepacket 302. - The
AP 108B can decode the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 304 at (7). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 304, theAP 108B determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) matches theAP 108B address or the wildcard address associated with theAP 108B at (8). TheAP 108B can then lock onto thepacket 304 and process the remaining portion of thepacket 304. - Alternatively or in addition, a
STA 110 can provide to an AP 108 information identifying a false alarm when theSTA 110 attempts to decode a data packet only to find that the destination address of the data packet does not match the address of theSTA 110. The AP 108 can gather information for one or more false alarms identified by the STA 110 (e.g., theSTA 110 can transmit, at separate times or at once, information for one or more false alarms identified by the STA 110), and use this information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110. For example, the AP 108 and/or theAP controller 106 can determine a statistic (e.g., the mean, median, mode, etc.) of the received power level (e.g., a power level at which a data packet is received) of the data packets that theSTA 110 identified as resulting in a false alarm, and the AP 108 and/orAP controller 106 can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110 to be some level above the determined statistic (e.g., some level above the mean, median, mode, etc.) of the received power level of the data packets that theSTA 110 identified as resulting in a false alarm. - In an alternative embodiment, the APs 108 can analyze the source address included in a header or preamble of a data packet instead of the destination address to minimize the negative effects of false alarms, and otherwise perform some or all of the other operations described herein. In particular, the APs 108 in the
multipoint environment 100 can each be configured to restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the source address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the source address does not match an address of aSTA 110 that has authenticated with one or more of the APs 108, use a minimum receive (Rx) sensitivity level below which the AP 108 does not attempt to decode the header or preamble of a data packet, or both restart a data packet detection procedure after decoding the source address in the header or preamble of a data packet and determining that the source address does not match an address an authenticatedSTA 110 and use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to decode the header or preamble of a data packet. On the other hand, an AP 108 may start processing and/or decoding a data packet if the AP 108 determines that the source address included in the header or preamble of the data packet matches an address of an authenticated STA 110 (e.g., aSTA 110 that has authenticated with the AP 108, the AP 108 or another AP 108 in a group of APs 108 has authenticated theSTA 110, etc.) and/or has a minimum Rx sensitivity level. - For example, instead of locking onto a data packet until transmission of the data packet is complete (e.g., transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the data packet is complete), an AP 108 can decode the header or preamble of a detected data packet to determine whether the source address included in the header or preamble matches an address of an authenticated
STA 110. If the source address in the header or preamble matches an address of an authenticatedSTA 110, the AP 108 locks onto the data packet and continues to process the remaining portion of the data packet, irrespective of whether the destination address included in the header or preamble of the data packet matches the address of the AP 108. If the source address in the header or preamble does not match an address of au authenticated STA 110 (indicating that the data packet is not intended for the AP 108), then the AP 108 can start searching for a new data packet without waiting for transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet to finish. In particular, the AP 108 can start a PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to detect transmissions of data packets (e.g., to begin detecting the transmission of a preamble, header, and/or data payload of a data packet). Upon detecting the transmission of a preamble or header of a data packet using the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure, the AP 108 can decode the source address included in the preamble or header. If the source address does not match the address of an authenticatedSTA 110, then the AP 108 can restart the PHY CCA and STF detection procedure to attempt to detect the transmission of another packet, even before transmission of the preamble, header, and/or data payload of the initial data packet is complete. -
FIG. 4 is a block diagram of themultipoint environment 100 ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of themultipoint environment 100 to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for aSTA 110A using false alarm information according to an embodiment. While the operations depicted inFIG. 4 are directed to determining a minimum Rx sensitivity level for aSTA 110, similar techniques can be used to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for an AP 108. - As illustrated in
FIG. 4 , theAP 108A transmitspacket 402 at time T1 to theSTA 110A at (1). For example, theAP 108A may initially transmit a header or preamble of thepacket 402. TheSTA 110A can detect the transmission and decode the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 402 at (2). After decoding the header (and/or preamble) of thepacket 402, theSTA 110A determines that the destination address in the header (or preamble) does not match theSTA 110A address at (3). As a result, theSTA 110A provides information to theAP 108A identifying the false alarm at (4). For example, the information can include the received power level of the packet 402 (e.g., a power level at which thepacket 402 is received by theSTA 110A), a destination address included in thepacket 402, a time that thepacket 402 was received by theSTA 110A, and/or the like. Alternatively or in addition, theSTA 110A may also begin looking for a new packet without waiting for completion of the transmission of thepacket 402. For example, theSTA 110A may begin searching for a new packet prior to the completion of the transmission of the header, preamble, and/or data payload of thepacket 402. - After the
AP 108A has received the false alarm information from theSTA 110A in response to transmission of thepacket 402 and/or after theAP 108A has received multiple instances of false alarm information in response to transmissions of different data packets, theAP 108A can determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110A at (5). For example, theAP 108A can average the data packet received power level(s) included in the received false alarm information, and select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110A that is at least some value above the average data packet received power level. Similarly, theAP 108A can determine a median data packet received power level, a mode data packet received power level, a standard deviation of the data packet received power level(s), a variance of the data packet received power level(s), etc., and select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110A that is at least some value over the determined data packet received power level statistic. Once the minimum Rx sensitivity level is determined, theAP 108A transmits the minimum Rx sensitivity level to theSTA 110A at (6). - The
STA 110A can now use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to begin decoding a data packet. For example, theAP 108B can transmit apacket 404 at a time T2 that is some time after the time T1 at (7). TheSTA 110A may detect the transmission of thepacket 404, but may ignore thepacket 404 at (8) (e.g., decline to decode the header and/or preamble of the packet 404) because the received power level of thepacket 404 is below the minimum Rx sensitivity level. - Alternatively or in addition, the AP 108 can gather information for one or more missed detects (e.g., data packet transmissions intended for a
STA 110 that were not received by the STA 110) and use this information alone or with the false alarm information to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110. For example, the AP 108 can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be some level below a statistic (e.g., a mean, median, mode, etc.) of a transmission power level of the data packets intended for theSTA 110 that were not received by theSTA 110. In particular, the AP 108 can set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be some level below a statistic of a transmission power level of the data packets intended for theSTA 110 that were not received by theSTA 110 minus an estimated path loss from the AP 108 to the STA 110 (where the path loss may be estimated by the AP 108 and/or the STA 110). The AP 108 can then provide the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to theSTA 110 so that theSTA 110 can begin using the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet. Similarly, an AP 108 can use missed detect information obtained from a STA 110 (e.g., information identifying data packets intended for the AP 108 that were not received by the AP 108) and/or false alarm information determined by the AP 108 (e.g., information associated with data packets decoded by the AP 108 that were not intended for the AP 108) to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for itself in a similar manner. The AP 108 can then use the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet. -
FIG. 5 is a block diagram of themultipoint environment 100 ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of themultipoint environment 100 to select a minimum Rx sensitivity level for aSTA 110A using missed detect information according to an embodiment. While the operations depicted inFIG. 5 are directed to determining a minimum Rx sensitivity level for aSTA 110, similar techniques can be used to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for an AP 108. - As illustrated in
FIG. 5 , theAP 108A transmits apacket 502 that includes a destination address of theSTA 110A at time T1 at (1). TheAP 108A can detect that theSTA 110A did not receive thepacket 502 at (2). For example, theAP 108A may detect that theSTA 110A did not receive thepacket 502 because theSTA 110A did not transmit an acknowledgement message to theAP 108A acknowledging receipt of thepacket 502 within a threshold period of time after time T1. As a result, theAP 108A can generate missed detect information, which includes a transmission power level of the packet 502 (and/or a power level at which thepacket 502 should have been received by theSTA 110A), a time that thepacket 502 was transmitted, a destination address of thepacket 502, and/or the like. - The
AP 108A can use the generated missed detect information and/or missed detect information derived from one or more other data packets transmitted to, but not received by, theSTA 110A to determine a minimum Rx sensitivity level for theSTA 110A at (3). For example, theAP 108A can average the transmission power level(s) of the data packets transmitted to, but not received by, theSTA 110A, and set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be at most some level below the average transmission power level (e.g., at most some level below the average transmission power level minus the estimated path loss from theAP 108A to theSTA 110A). Similarly, theAP 108A can determine a median transmission power level, a mode transmission power level, a standard deviation of the transmission power level(s), a variance of the transmission power level(s), and/or the like of the data packets transmitted to, but not received by, theSTA 110A, and set the minimum Rx sensitivity level to be at most some level below the statistic of the transmission power level (e.g., at most some level below the statistic of the transmission power level minus the estimated path loss from theAP 108A to theSTA 110A). Once the minimum Rx sensitivity level is determined, theAP 108A transmits the minimum Rx sensitivity level to theSTA 110A at (4). - The
STA 110A can now use the minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether to begin decoding a data packet. For example, the AP 108 b can transmit apacket 504 at a time T2 that is some time after the time T1 at (5). TheSTA 110A may detect the transmission of thepacket 504, but may ignore thepacket 504 at (6) (e.g., decline to decode the header and/or preamble of the packet 504) because the received power level (or transmission power level) of thepacket 504 is below the minimum Rx sensitivity level. - In alternate embodiments, the
AP controller 106, jointly or separate from an AP 108, can determine the minimum Rx sensitivity level. TheAP controller 106 can determine the minimum Rx sensitivity level in the same manner as the AP 108 as described herein. - By configuring a
STA 110 or AP 108 to restart the data packet detection procedure soon after identifying that a destination address does not match an address (or wildcard address) of aSTA 110 or AP 108 and/or to use a minimum Rx sensitivity level to determine whether or not to begin decoding a preamble or header of a transmitted data packet, themultipoint environment 100 increases the reliability and reduces the latency of a wireless network. For example, reliability may be increased because aSTA 110 or AP 108 is less likely to miss a data packet intended for theSTA 110 or AP 108 given that theSTA 110 or AP 108 is no longer waiting for transmission of a data packet to finish before searching for a new data packet. Latency of the wireless network may be reduced because aSTA 110 or AP 108 may no longer decode all detected data packets. Rather, theSTA 110 or AP 108 may only decode those data packets that have a received power level over a minimum Rx sensitivity level, which may cause theSTA 110 or AP 108 to decode sooner those data packets actually intended for theSTA 110 or AP 108. - The
AP controller 106 may further increase reliability and reduce latency in the wireless network by implementing retransmission diversity. For example, transmission of a data packet from an AP 108 to aSTA 110 or from aSTA 110 to an AP 108 may fail due to an obstruction (e.g., by an object, such as a wall, a human, furniture, etc.) and/or interference (e.g., from another transmitting device, such as an AP 108 or STA 110) being present. Generally, the data packet may be retransmitted in response to the initial transmission failure. Retransmitting the data packet from thesame STA 110 or AP 108 is likely to result in another transmission failure, however, because retransmissions generally occur soon after the initial transmission (e.g., 1 ms after, 10 ms after, 100 ms after, etc.) and the obstruction and/or interference is still likely to be present given the short timeframe between transmissions. Thus, in the event of a data packet transmission failure, theAP controller 106 can trigger a retransmission of the data packet from anotherSTA 110 or AP 108, such as from aSTA 110 or AP 108 that has a different spatial location than theSTA 110 or AP 108 that originally transmitted the data packet. Accordingly, the retransmission is less likely to be affected by the obstruction and/or interference, and therecipient STA 110 or AP 108 is then more likely to receive the retransmitted data packet. As an illustrative example, in the event of a data packet transmission failure by a first AP 108 that originally transmitted a data packet, theAP controller 106 can trigger a retransmission of the data packet by a second AP 108 in place of the first AP 108, where the second AP 108 may have a different spatial location than the first AP 108. - In addition, the
AP controller 106 can pre-cache a data packet at one or more APs 108, even before the AP 108 that is originally assigned to transmit the data packet transmits the data packet. For example, there may be a time delay involved in anAP controller 106 transmitting a data packet to an AP 108 so that the AP 108 can transmit the data packet to aSTA 110. Pre-caching the data packet at multiple APs 108 before the data packet is transmitted by any AP 108 (and therefore before a transmission failure occurs) may reduce the time it takes for a second AP 108 to retransmit the data packet if the first transmission of the data packet fails. Thus, if the transmission by a first AP 108 that is originally assigned to transmit the data packet fails, theAP controller 106 can instruct a second AP 108 at which the data packet has already been pre-cached to transmit the data packet. The time waiting for the second AP 108 to receive the data packet from theAP controller 106 is therefore eliminated. Thus, the time from when theAP controller 106 determines that the second AP 108 should retransmit the data packet to when the second AP 108 retransmits the data packet is reduced, thereby reducing the latency involved with retransmitting the data packet. -
FIGS. 6A-6B are block diagrams of themultipoint environment 100 ofFIG. 1A illustrating the operations performed by the components of themultipoint environment 100 to pre-cache data packets according to an embodiment. As illustrated inFIG. 6A , theAP controller 106 pre-caches adata packet 602 at theAP 108A and instructs the -
AP 108A to transmit thepacket 602 at a time T1 at (1A). For example, theAP controller 106 can pre-cache thepacket 602 at theAP 108A by transmitting thepacket 602 data to theAP 108A. Before, during, and/or after pre-caching thepacket 602 at theAP 108A, theAP controller 106 pre-caches thepacket 602 at theAP 108B. TheAP controller 106, however, does not immediately instruct theAP 108B to transmit thepacket 602. - At time T1, the
AP 108A can transmit thepacket 602 with a destination address of theSTA 110A at (2). TheAP 108A may detect that theSTA 110A did not receive the packet at (3) because, for example, no acknowledgement message was received from theSTA 110A acknowledging receipt of thepacket 602. As a result, theAP 108A can transmit to theAP controller 106 an indication that theSTA 110A did not receive thepacket 602 at (4). TheAP controller 106 can then instruct theAP 108B to transmit thepacket 602 at (5), and theAP 108B can transmit thepacket 602 to theSTA 110A at (6). - As illustrated at
FIG. 6B , theAP controller 106 can optionally transmit an indication to thebaseband unit 140 that theAP 108B is transmitting to theSTA 110A in place of theAP 108A at (7). Thebaseband unit 140 can use this information to schedule future data packets to theSTA 110A to be served by theAP 108B instead of theAP 108A, at least until the next active set selection procedure is performed to select one or more APs 108 and/or one or more beams to serve theSTA 110A. - Alternatively or in addition, the
STA 110A can transmit to theAP 108B an indication that theSTA 110A is not seeing a beam from theAP 108A that was originally assigned in an active set to serve theSTA 110A at (8). TheSTA 110A may further indicate a beam that theSTA 110A can see from another AP, such as from theAP 108B. TheAP 108B can forward this indication to theAP controller 106 at (9), and theAP controller 106 can forward this indication to thebaseband unit 140 at (10). Thebaseband unit 140 can use this information to schedule future data packets to theSTA 110A to be served by a beam other than the beam of theAP 108A originally assigned in active set to serve theSTA 110A. For example, the other beam may be the beam from theAP 108B that theSTA 110A can see or detect. This beam may be temporarily assigned to theSTA 110A until the next active set selection procedure is performed to select one or more APs 108 and/or one or more beams to serve theSTA 110A. - In one embodiment, the
baseband unit 140 uses the updated AP 108 serving information provided by theAP controller 106 and/or the beam information provided by theSTA 110A to provide to theAP controller 106 data for anew packet 604 and an instruction to instruct theAP 108B (and/or a particular beam of theAP 108B) to transmit thepacket 604 at (11). Thus, new packets can be transmitted to theSTA 110A in a manner that may avoid the obstruction or interference causing transmission issues. -
FIG. 7 is a flow diagram depicting apacket detection routine 700 illustratively implemented by a STA and/or an AP, according to one embodiment. As an example, aSTA 110A-D and/or anAP 108A-I can be configured to execute thepacket detection routine 700. Thepacket detection routine 700 begins atblock 702. - At
block 702, a header (and/or a preamble) of a first packet is decoded. For example, the header and/or preamble of the first packet may be decoded in order to determine whether the packet is intended for the decoding device (e.g., aSTA 110 or an AP 108). - At
block 704, a determination is made that the destination address in the header (and/or the preamble) does not match a device address. For example, the destination address may not match aSTA 110 address or the destination address may not match an AP 108 address or a wildcard address associated with an AP 108. - At
block 706, the device begins to look for another packet before transmission of the first packet is complete. For example, rather than waiting for transmission of the first packet is complete before looking for another packet, theSTA 110 or AP 108 can immediate unlock from the first packet upon determining that the destination address does not match the address or wildcard address of theSTA 110 or AP 108. -
FIG. 8 is a flow diagram depicting a minimum Rxsensitivity selection routine 800 illustratively implemented by an AP, an AP controller, and/or a STA according to one embodiment. As an example, the AP 108, theAP controller 106, and/or theSTA 110 can be configured to execute the minimum Rxsensitivity selection routine 800. The minimum Rxsensitivity selection routine 800 begins atblock 802. - At
block 802, a packet is transmitted to a device. For example, the packet can be transmitted to aSTA 110 or an AP 108. - At
block 804, information is received indicating that a false alarm occurred. For example, the information can be received by an AP 108 from aSTA 110 or can be generated by the AP 108 in response to a packet transmitted by aSTA 110. The information can include an indication of a received power level of the packet. - At
block 806, a minimum Rx sensitivity level is determined for the device based at least in part on the received information. For example, the minimum Rx sensitivity level may be based on the received information and previously received false alarm information associated with previously transmitted packets to the device. The minimum Rx sensitivity level may be set to a level that is at least some level above the received power level of the packet and/or at least some level above a statistic derived from the received power level of the packet and/or received power level(s) of other transmitted packet(s). - At
block 808, the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level is transmitted to the device. For example, the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level can be transmitted to aSTA 110. As another example, the determined minimum Rx sensitivity level can be transmitted to an AP 108 from anAP controller 106. This operation may be optional if, for example, the AP 108 determines a minimum Rx sensitivity level for itself. -
FIG. 9 is a flow diagram depicting apacket detection routine 900 illustratively implemented by a STA, according to one embodiment. As an example, aSTA 110A-D can be configured to execute thepacket detection routine 900. Thepacket detection routine 900 begins atblock 902. - At
block 902, authentication with one or more access points is performed. For example, the STA may request to be authenticated with any one of multiple access points in a single wireless protocol stack. - At
block 904, a first portion of a first packet transmitted by a first access point in the one or more access points is decoded. For example, the first portion of the first packet may be a header or preamble of the first packet. - At
block 906, a determination is made that a destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address of the wireless computing device (e.g., the STA). For example, the address can be the Internet protocol (IP) address of the STA. - At
block 908, the first packet is processed in response to the determination that the destination address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the wireless computing device, irrespective of a source address included in the first portion of the first packet. For example, the STA can lock onto and process the remaining portion of the first packet (e.g., the data payload of the first packet) in response to determining that the destination address in the first portion of the first packet matches the address of the STA. -
FIG. 10 is a flow diagram depicting apacket detection routine 1000 illustratively implemented by an AP, according to one embodiment. As an example, anAP 108A-I can be configured to execute thepacket detection routine 1000. Thepacket detection routine 1000 begins atblock 1002. - At
block 1002, a wireless communication device is authenticated. For example, the wireless communication device can be a STA. The wireless communication device may be authenticated in response to a request from the wireless communication device. Authentication by theAP 108A-I may result in the wireless communication device being authenticated with theAP 108A-I and/or with one or moreother APs 108A-I that are within a single wireless protocol stack. - At
block 1004, a first portion of a first packet transmitted by the wireless communication device is decoded. For example, the first portion of the first packet may be a header or preamble of the first packet. - At
block 1006, a determination is made that an address included in the first portion of the first packet matches an address associated with the wireless computing device. For example, the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a source address in a header or preamble of the first packet. As another example, the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a wildcard address associated with the AP, which can be the address of the wireless computing device (e.g., a STA). As another example, the address associated with the wireless communication device is an address of the wireless communication device. As another example, the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a source address that matches the address of the wireless communication device. As another example, the address included in the first portion of the first packet can be a source address that matches the address of the authenticated wireless communication device. - At
block 1008, the first packet is processed in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless computing device, irrespective of whether the first packet includes an address of the access point. For example, the AP can lock onto and process the remaining portion of the first packet (e.g., the data payload of the first packet) in response to determining that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless computing device. The AP can process the first packet whether the first portion of the first packet includes the address of the AP as a destination address. For example, the destination address could be a wildcard address, the address of another AP, or the address of the AP. In further embodiments, the AP can verify that the wireless communication device is authenticated (e.g., authenticated with the AP and/or with one or more other APs in the same wireless protocol stack) and process the first packet in response to the determination that the wireless communication device is authenticated and in response to the determination that the address included in the first portion of the first packet matches the address associated with the wireless computing device. -
FIG. 11 is a block diagram illustrating anexample baseband unit 1102 andremote radio unit 1190 according to an embodiment. Thebaseband unit 1102 may be coupled with at least oneremote radio unit 1190. Theremote radio unit 1190 may include at least afirst antenna 1196 and asecond antenna 1198 for MIMO wireless communications. Any antenna disclosed herein, such as theantenna 1196 or theantenna 1198, can be referred to as antenna element. Thefirst antenna 1196 and thesecond antenna 1198 may be coupled with a RFfront end 1194. The RFfront end 1194 may process signals received via thefirst antenna 1196 and thesecond antenna 1198. Part of processing a signal may include transmitting the signal to atransceiver 1120 included in theBBU 1102. - A
processor 1105 may receive signals received by thetransceiver 1120. Theprocessor 1105 may be configured to determine a type of the signal. For example, if the signal includes a request for connection services, theprocessor 1105 may provide the signal to anactive set selector 1135. Theactive set selector 1135 may be configured to identify an active set of serving nodes to provide the requested downlink data transmission service. Theactive set selector 1135 can identify the active set for a STA based on information associated with the STA. Alternatively or additionally, theactive set selector 1135 can identify the active set for a STA based on information associated with one or more other STAs. In some instances, theactive set selector 1135 can identify specific spatial beam(s) selected to serve a STA. TheBBU 1102 may include anetwork monitor 1125 to detect characteristics of the network such as the number of STAs served by each RRU, network data transmission load, and/or the like. Theactive set selector 1135 may receive the network characteristics from thenetwork monitor 1125 as a factor considered when selecting spatial beam(s) to serve a STA and/or identifying an active set for a STA. - A
beamformer 1115 may be included in theBBU 1102 to further identify parameters for the serving nodes (e.g., RRUs) included in an active set. The parameters may include one or more of transmission mode, time, frequency, power, beamforming matrix, tone allocation, or channel rank. Thebeamformer 1115 may determine optimal parameters for RRUs coupled with theBBU 1102 that facilitate a network-wide optimization of downlink data transmissions. In some implementations, theactive set selector 1135 determines an active set for a STA based, in part, on information provided by the STA. In other implementations, a UE may provide a requested active set. TheBBU 1102 may include anactive set arbitrator 1130 to reconcile a requested active set with an active set selected by theactive set selector 1135. Theactive set arbitrator 1130 may compare a requested set of serving nodes to the serving nodes identified by theactive set selector 1135. The comparison may include ordering the serving nodes according to the STA recommendation. In some implementations, theactive set arbitrator 1130 may provide a message to the STA indicating confirmation or other assessment for a requested active set. For example, if the STA requested nodes A and B but theBBU 1102 identified only B in the active set, the message may include a code indicating a partial match for the active set. Other status codes may be included to facilitate efficient communication and assessment of requested active sets. Theactive set arbitrator 1130 may additionally or alternatively compare a requested transmission mode to the transmission mode identified by theactive set selector 1135 or other element of theBBU 1102. - The
BBU 1102 may include adata store 1110. Thedata store 1110 may include instructions that can be executed by theprocessor 1105 to implement the features described herein. In some implementations, thedata store 1110 may retain active sets or other scheduling information assigned to STAs served by theBBU 1102 and/or channel state information. Thedata store 1110 may be indexed by STA identifier and/or RRU identifier. This can expedite identification of previously communicated scheduling information for the STA and for monitoring network conditions (e.g., number of STAs allocated to an RRU or antenna element of an RRU). - In addition to providing the scheduling information to the STA, the scheduling information may be used to configure the
RRU 1190. The configuration may include adjusting thefirst antenna 1196 such as by frequency modulation, time modulation, altering transmission power from apower source 1192, or adjusting direction, tone allocation, or beamforming of the transmission. - As discussed above, a variety of different STAs can wirelessly communicate with serving nodes in a cooperative MIMO network. An example STA will be discussed with reference to
FIG. 12 . -
FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of anexample STA 1200 according to an embodiment. TheSTA 1200 is configured for wirelessly communicating with a base station in a cooperative MIMO network. As illustrated inFIG. 12 , theSTA 1200 includes aprocessor 1240, auser interface 1245, adata store 1250, abeamformer 1255,antennas 1262 and 1264, atransceiver 1265, amotion detector 1270, asignal quality analyzer 1275, and anactive set selector 1280. Some other STAs can include additional elements and/or a subset of the elements illustrated inFIG. 12 . - The
STA 1200 includes a plurality ofantennas 1262 and 1264. Any suitable number of antennas can be included for wireless communication. TheSTA 1200 can include one or more arrays of antennas. A radio frequency (RF)front end 1260 can process RF signals received via theantennas 1262 and 1264. The RF front end can also provide RF signals to theantennas 1262 and 1264 for transmission. Thetransceiver 1265 includes a transmitter and a receiver. Thetransceiver 1265 can provide processing for transmitting and receiving RF signals associated with theantennas 1262 and 1264. For example, upon receiving active set data, theprocessor 1240 can configure the transceiver 1265 (e.g., receiver) to receive DL data associated with the spatial beam(s) identified in the active set data as being selected to serve theSTA 1200. - The
processor 1240 is in communication with thetransceiver 1265. Theprocessor 1240 is implemented by physical hardware arranged to perform specific operations to implement functionality related to determining a link strength of spatial beams over which beam pilots and/or user data are transmitted. Theprocessor 1240 can determine the link strength, identify a spatial beam that provides the best link strength, and/or generate one or more messages to report the link strength to a serving node in accordance with any suitable principles and advantages disclosed herein. Theprocessor 1240 can cause active set and neighbor set data to be stored and updated. Theprocessor 1240 can perform any other suitable processing for theSTA 1200. - The
processor 1240 can be in communication with themotion detector 1270 and thesignal quality analyzer 1275. Accordingly, theprocessor 1240 can receive and process information associated with conditions of theSTA 1200. Themotion detector 1270 can include any suitable hardware arranged to detect mobility information associated with theSTA 1200. Thesignal quality analyzer 1275 can analyze the quality of signals received and/or transmitted by theantennas 1262 and 1264. This can provide information associated with a spatial channel condition of theSTA 1200. The information associated with conditions of theSTA 1200 can be provided to theprocessor 1240 for providing to the serving node(s). In some instances, some or all of the functionality of themotion detector 1270 and/or the signal quality analyzer can be implemented by theprocessor 1240. - The
active set selector 1280 is optional and can identify a desired active set of one or more serving nodes. Theactive set selector 1280 can select the desired active set based on data associated with one or more of: one or more serving nodes in the active set, one or more serving nodes in the neighbor set, mobility data associated with theUE 1200, a spatial channel condition associated with theSTA 1200, the link strength and/or the link quality of one or more spatial beams served by one or more serving nodes, or one or more characteristics of theSTA 1200. Theactive set selector 1280 can optionally execute the active set management scheme to identify a desired active set. Theactive set selector 1280 can cause theprocessor 1240 to generate a message for transmission to a serving node and/or a BBU to request that a selected spatial beam (or selected spatial beams) be added to an active set for the STA 1200 (e.g., request that a selected spatial beam, which may be different than the spatial beam(s) already included in an active set for theSTA 1200, be included in an updated active set for the STA 1200). Theactive set selector 1280 can be implemented by dedicated circuitry and/or circuitry of theprocessor 1240. - The
beamformer 1255 can perform any suitable beamforming functionality for theSTA 1200. Thebeamformer 1255 can set and/or adjust one or more parameters associated with receiving and/or transmitting signals associated with theantennas 1262 and 1264 of theSTA 1200. Thebeamformer 1255 can be implemented by dedicated circuitry and/or circuitry of theprocessor 1240. - The
STA 1240 includes adata store 1250. Thedata store 1250 can store instructions that can be executed by theprocessor 1240 to implement the features described herein. Thedata store 1250 can store active set data and neighbor set data for theSTA 1200. Thedata store 1250 can store spatial beam link strengths and/or link qualities. Thedata store 1250 can store any other suitable data for theSTA 1200. Thedata store 1250 can include any suitable memory elements arranged to store data. - Several elements included in the
STA 1200 may be coupled by abus 1290. Thebus 1290 can be a data bus, communication bus, other bus, or any suitable combination thereof to enable the various components of theSTA 1200 to exchange information. - As illustrated in
FIG. 12 , theSTA 1200 also includes auser interface 1245. Theuser interface 1245 can be any suitable user interface, such as a display and/or an audio component. In some instances, theuser interface 1245 can include one or more of touch screen capabilities, a button, a knob, a switch, or a slider. - As described above, a
STA 110 may miss a data packet transmission intended for theSTA 110 if theSTA 110 is decoding a preamble or header of another data packet while the header or preamble of desired data packet is being transmitted.FIG. 13 illustrates an example timeline for packet transmissions from an AP 108 to aSTA 110, depicting reasons why a data packet transmission miss may occur. - In one timeline (e.g., packet for
STA 110 timeline), aSTA 110 begins searching for a data packet at (1). After successfully identifying a data packet, theSTA 110 may decode a preamble or header of the data packet and determine that the preamble or header has a destination address that matches the address of theSTA 110 at (2). TheSTA 110 may then continue decoding the payload of the data packet at (3). Once the preamble or header and/or payload are decoded and a guard time has passed, theSTA 110 can transmit an ACK or NAK at (4) to the AP 108 that transmitted the data packet and/or to another AP 108, such as another AP 108 that shares the same wireless protocol stack as the packet transmitted AP 108 as described herein. TheSTA 110 then begins searching for another data packet at (5). The total transmission and/or processing time from transmission of the beginning of the header to transmission of the end of the ACK may be time Tx. The transmission time for theSTA 110 to transmit the ACK or NAK may be Ta. - In a second timeline (e.g., packet not for
STA 110 timeline), aSTA 110 begins searching for a data packet at (6). After successfully identifying a data packet, theSTA 110 may decode a preamble or header of a data packet and determine that the preamble or header has a destination address that does not match the address of theSTA 110 at (7). TheSTA 110 then aborts the payload decode and continues searching at (8) for a preamble or header of another data packet. The total transmission and/or processing time from the transmission of the beginning of the header to the start of the search at (8) is time Td. - In a third timeline (e.g.,
STA 110B processing ACK fromSTA 110A timeline), aSTA 110B begins searching for a data packet at (9). After successfully identifying and decoding an ACK and/or NAK transmitted by anotherSTA 110A, theSTA 110B finishes processing the ACK and/or NAK at (10) and continues searching for another data packet at (11). The total transmission and/or processing time from the transmission of the beginning of the ACK and/or NAK to the start of the search at (11) may be time Tap. The difference between Tap and Ta may be the time beyond the transmission of the ACK and/or NAK for theSTA 110B to complete the processing of the ACK and/or NAK and restart the search processing at (11). - As described above, pre-empting full data packet processing in a manner as described above with respect to
FIG. 2 and elsewhere in this disclosure (e.g., based on determining whether the destination address in a header or preamble matches a destination address of a receiving device, based on determining whether a source address in a header or preamble matches an address of an authenticated device, etc.) can reduce the likelihood that aSTA 110 misses a transmission from an AP 108 that is intended for theSTA 110 and that is transmitted while theSTA 110 is processing a false alarm data packet (e.g., a data packet not intended for theSTA 110, a data packet intended for anotherSTA 110, a data packet transmitted by an AP 108 with which theSTA 110 has not authenticated, etc.). However, aSTA 110 may still miss some transmissions intended for theSTA 110 as depicted inFIG. 13 . Synchronizing and/or temporarily coordinating APs 108 may alleviate this issue. -
FIG. 14 illustrates a synchronized system in which AP 108 packet transmission times are synchronized to a raster. As illustrated inFIG. 14 , theAP 108A-C transmission start times may be offset on a raster with spacing time Tr. Given N APs 108 and N raster offsets (with one offset assigned to each AP 108 by, for example, an AP controller 106), an AP 108 may transmit a data packet at start time index n if -
(n−offset) modulo N=0 - The raster may ensure that one AP 108 is transmitting a header during any raster interval (e.g., multiple APs 108 may not transmit a header during the same raster interval). As a result, if a
STA 110 detects a preamble for a data packet not intended for theSTA 110, as long as theSTA 110 can process and/or abort the processing of the header prior to the next raster start time, theSTA 110 may not miss a preamble of a data packet actually intended for the STA 110 (e.g., given that subsequent preambles may be transmitted by APs 108 after the prior raster start time completes). In other words, theSTAs 110 can continue to process preambles or headers in a manner as described herein, and abort the processing if the destination address in the header or preamble does not match the address of therespective STA 110. However, the APs 108 may be coordinated such that the APs 108 refrain from transmitting preambles or headers at the same time and/or overlapping in time. This may ensure that, at least due to AP 108 preamble false alarms, theSTAs 110 are in a search state at the beginning of a raster interval if theSTAs 110 are not already processing a data packet that is directed to therespective STA 110. These operations may reduce the likelihood that STAs 110 miss data packets due to the processing of preambles or headers that are for data packets not actually intended for theSTAs 110. - For example,
AP 108A may start 1402 transmitting a header or preamble of a data packet attime 0. BecauseFIG. 14 illustrates threeAPs 108A-C in the network, the next raster interval during which theAP 108A can transmit is time 3Tr. At time 3Tr, theAP 108A transmits aheader 1404 and, some time later, transmits apayload 1406 of a second data packet.AP 108B, however, may start transmitting preambles or headers at time Tr andAP 108C may start transmitting preambles or headers at time 2Tr. The data packet transmitted by theAP 108B at time Tr, however, may be large and the amount of time to transmit the full data packet may pass the next raster interval, 4Tr, assigned to theAP 108B. As a result, theAP 108B may not transmit a second packet until the following raster interval, 7Tr. Similarly, while theAP 108C can transmit during the raster interval starting at 2Tr, theAP 108C does not need to transmit during this raster interval. Here, theAP 108C does not transmit any data packets during this raster interval. TheAP 108C then waits until the next raster interval, 5Tr, to transmit a preamble or header and payload of a data packet. - To ensure that a
STA 110 is in a data packet search state at the beginning of a raster interval (e.g., at a raster start time), the raster step Tr may be at least equal to the maximum time, Td, for aSTA 110 to process and abort processing a preamble that has a mismatched destination (e.g., has a destination address that does not match the address of the STA 110). For example, the raster time interval, Tr, may be as follows: -
Tr>Td - In an embodiment, the
AP controller 106 could assign everyAP 108A-C in a system a unique raster offset or interval. For N APs 108, the period of start times for a given AP may be N*Tr. For large N, this could lead to significant inefficiencies given long idle transmission times waiting for the next raster start time. In another embodiment, theAP controller 106 can assign APs 108 the same offset if the APs 108 are sufficiently spaced from a path loss perspective. For example, ifAP 108A is outside the coverage ofSTAs 110 associated withAP 108B, theAPs 108A-B could be assigned the same offset given that it is unlikely that theSTAs 110 associated withAP 108B will process preambles or headers of data packets transmitted by theAP 108A since such data packets may be below a configured minimum sensitivity threshold (e.g., such as the minimum Rx sensitivity level described above). These operations may be a form of raster offset re-use (e.g., multiple APs 108 can use the same raster interval to transmit preambles or headers). As an illustrative example, assuming a cellular deployment topology, an offset re-use of 7 or 21 could yield the same or similar false alarm reduction performance as an arbitrarily large N in which unique raster offsets are used. - In another embodiment, to reduce the idle transmission times associated with strict raster start times, some APs 108 may be assigned optional data packet transmit times other than or in addition to the assigned raster offset. For example, if an AP 108 raster start time has just passed, the AP 108 may still transmit a preamble or header (or data packet) during the next raster interval (subject to an exception criterion). The exception criterion may limit such exceptions so that most preamble or header transmission are aligned to the assigned raster offset (e.g., occur during the assigned raster interval). Non-offset aligning (e.g., an AP 108 transmitting a preamble or header outside of an assigned raster interval) may result in one or more STAs 110 missing packet transmissions due to preamble or header transmission overlaps. If the relative frequency of non-offset aligned preamble or header transmissions is low compared to the total packet transmission, however, the impact on overall system false alarm reduction performance may be minimized. As an example, an exception criterion may be the minimum run length of offset aligned transmissions between exceptions. In particular, a run-length of 9 data packets would ensure at most one non-offset aligned preamble or header transmission every transmission of 10 data packets during an assigned raster interval. As another example, an exception criterion may define that an AP 108 is allowed to start transmission of a preamble or header during the assigned raster interval with
probability 1 and within any other raster interval with probability p. For non-assigned raster interval transmission, a random coin toss event (e.g., a random number generator) can determine if a transmission of a preamble or header by an AP 108 not assigned to the current raster interval can start. The probabilistic approach may ensure exceptions are uniformly distributed and the value of p may allow the fraction of non-offset aligned transmissions to be controlled. - In another embodiment, to reduce the idle transmission times, some APs 108 may be assigned raster intervals or offsets (e.g., by the AP controller 106) if the APs 108 have active queues of data packets to be scheduled. This may be a form a dynamic raster interval re-use, with the number of raster offsets N and the offset assignments being reconfigured depending on the active APs 108 (e.g., the APs 108 having active queues of data packets to be scheduled). In an extreme case of only one active AP 108, the raster may offset N may equal 1 and the
AP controller 106 may assign a single offset. In this case the AP 108 could start preamble or header transmission on any raster interval Tr. An alternative to semi-static reassignment of the offsets is to extend the probabilistic approach described above without changing the set of raster offsets N. For example, an AP can start transmission at the assigned offset withprobability 1. For a specified set of offsets that are associated with idle or unassigned offsets, the start probability may be q, and for all other offsets with other active APs 108, the start probability may be p. Typically, the relative probabilities q>p may bias transmissions to idle AP 108 offsets versus known active AP 108 offsets. - Not only can the transmission of preambles or headers that are processed by
STAs 110 for which the transmission is not intended result in false alarms (e.g., false decodes), but also the ACK or NAK transmitted by STAs 110 can cause false alarms and missed data packets as well. For example, theSTA 110 ACK and/or NAK, which is directed to the serving AP 108, may also be decoded byother STAs 110. If the ACK and/or NAK decode processing happens to overlap with the preamble of a transmission directed to theSTA 110, a missed packet can result. -
FIG. 15 illustrates a timeline of ACK and/or NAK transmission that may reduce the likelihood that ACK and/or NAK transmissions result in missed AP 108 preambles. As illustrated inFIG. 15 ,STAs 110 may be configured to start transmission of an ACK or NAK at least a hold time Th after the start of the raster interval and/or after the start of a transmission of a preamble orheader 1502. By theAP controller 106, APs 108, and/or STAs 110 ensuring that transmission of the ACK and/or NAK lags transmission of a preamble or header during the same raster interval with sufficient margin to offset synchronization and other delays, theSTAs 110 may detect the preamble or header first and before the ACK and/or NAK. In addition, theSTAs 110 may be configured such that transmission of the ACK and/or NAK may be complete with sufficient setup time Ts, before the next raster start time (e.g., before the start of the next raster interval), such as the next time an AP 108 is eligible to transmit aheader 1504. By theAP controller 106, APs 108, and/or STAs 110 ensuring that the ACK and/or NAK is transmitted after transmission of the preamble orheader 1502 during a given raster interval with sufficient margin to allow the ACK and/or NAK to be processed prior to completion of the raster interval, with a time margin to offset synchronization and other delays, theSTAs 110 may be in a search state at the start of a raster interval and ready to detect any preambles orheaders 1504 transmitted by an AP 108 after the current raster interval. Furthermore, the raster interval duration may be at least equal to the ACK and/or NAK transmission time, Ta, plus the setup time Ts and hold Th time. For example, theSTAs 110 may be configured to follow the following transmission settings: -
T r >T h +T a +T s -
(T x −T a ) modulo T r >T h -
T r −T x modulo T r >T s - Tx may be adjusted by the
AP controller 106 and/or the APs 108 to ensure that the false alarm likelihood is reduced. The time Tx may be a function of the transmission MCS, number packets, etc. To adjust the time Tx time, anAP controller 106 and/or an AP 108 can pad the transmission and extend the time Tx to ensure that the false alarm likelihood is reduced. As described herein, if the above-described transmission settings can be met, the likelihood of false alarms may be greatly reduced. - In some embodiments, data packets transmitted by a serving AP 108 that have been successfully decoded by a
STA 110 may still be retransmitted by the serving AP 108 if the confirmation ACK transmitted by theSTA 110 is not successfully decoded by the serving AP 108. Similar to overlapping packet preambles that may result inSTA 110 preamble missed detection (e.g., aSTA 110 missing a preamble of a data packet intended for theSTA 110 because theSTA 110 is currently processing a preamble of another data packet that actually is not intended for the STA 110), the ACK transmitted by aSTA 110 may be missed by the receiving AP 108 if the receiving AP 108 is processing a preamble transmitted by another AP 108 at the time that the ACK is transmitted. The AP 108 may begin searching for a preamble of an ACK and/or NAK after the data packet transmission is complete. By ensuring that the AP 108 is configured to delay starting the search for a preamble of an ACK and/or NAK, such as by at least the preamble hold time Th (e.g., at least a hold time Th after the start of the raster interval and/or after the start of a transmission of a preamble or header of a data packet), any preambles transmitted by other APs 108 may be missed, thereby avoiding a false detection that could overlap with the ACK and/or NAK detection. For example, the ACK time (e.g., the ACK transmission time) can be extended to include the guard time between the end of the data packet transmission and the start of the ACK and/or NAK transmission. Equivalently, Ta can be the total time from the end of the data packet transmission to the end of the ACK transmission. - In any of the approaches or embodiments described above, the
AP controller 106 may assign raster offsets or intervals or otherwise assign settings or parameters for APs 108 and/or STAs 110 that govern AP 108 and/orSTA 110 transmissions and/or timing. - Depending on the embodiment, certain acts, events, or functions of any of the processes or algorithms described herein can be performed in a different sequence, can be added, merged, or left out altogether (e.g., not all described operations or events are necessary for the practice of the algorithm). Moreover, in certain embodiments, operations, or events can be performed concurrently, e.g., through multi-threaded processing, interrupt processing, or multiple processors or processor cores or on other parallel architectures, rather than sequentially.
- Conditional language used herein, such as, among others, “can,” “could,” “might,” “may,” “e.g.,” and the like, unless specifically stated otherwise, or otherwise understood within the context as used, is generally intended to convey that certain embodiments include, while other embodiments do not include, certain features, elements, and/or steps. Thus, such conditional language is not generally intended to imply that features, elements, and/or steps are in any way required for one or more embodiments or that one or more embodiments necessarily include logic for deciding, with or without other input or prompting, whether these features, elements, and/or steps are included or are to be performed in any particular embodiment. The terms “comprising,” “including,” “having,” and the like are synonymous and are used inclusively, in an open-ended fashion, and do not exclude additional elements, features, acts, operations, and so forth. Additionally, the words “herein,” “above,” “below,” and words of similar import, when used in this application, shall refer to this application as a whole and not to any particular portions of this application. Where the context permits, words in the above Detailed Description of Certain Embodiments using the singular or plural may also include the plural or singular, respectively. Also, the term “or” is used in its inclusive sense (and not in its exclusive sense) so that when used, for example, to connect a list of elements, the term “or” means one, some, or all of the elements in the list.
- Disjunctive language such as the phrase “at least one of X, Y, Z,” unless specifically stated otherwise, is otherwise understood with the context as used in general to present that an item, term, etc., may be either X, Y, or Z, or any combination thereof (e.g., X, Y, and/or Z). Thus, such disjunctive language is not generally intended to, and should not, imply that certain embodiments require at least one of X, at least one of Y, or at least one of Z to each be present.
- Unless otherwise explicitly stated, articles such as “a” or “an” should generally be interpreted to include one or more described items. Accordingly, phrases such as “a device configured to” are intended to include one or more recited devices. Such one or more recited devices can also be collectively configured to carry out the stated recitations. For example, “a processor configured to carry out recitations A, B and C” can include a first processor configured to carry out recitation A working in conjunction with a second processor configured to carry out recitations B and C.
- The word “coupled,” as generally used herein, refers to two or more elements that may be either directly coupled to each other, or coupled by way of one or more intermediate elements. Likewise, the word “connected,” as generally used herein, refers to two or more elements that may be either directly connected, or connected by way of one or more intermediate elements.
- As used herein, the terms “determine” or “determining” encompass a wide variety of actions. For example, “determining” may include calculating, computing, processing, deriving, generating, obtaining, looking up (e.g., looking up in a table, a database or another data structure), ascertaining and the like via a hardware element without user intervention. Also, “determining” may include receiving (e.g., receiving information), accessing (e.g., accessing data in a memory) and the like via a hardware element without user intervention. Also, “determining” may include resolving, selecting, choosing, establishing, and the like via a hardware element without user intervention.
- As used herein, the terms “provide” or “providing” encompass a wide variety of actions. For example, “providing” may include storing a value in a location of a storage device for subsequent retrieval, transmitting a value directly to the recipient via at least one wired or wireless communication medium, transmitting or storing a reference to a value, and the like. “Providing” may also include encoding, decoding, encrypting, decrypting, validating, verifying, and the like via a hardware element.
- As used herein, the term “message” encompasses a wide variety of formats for communicating (e.g., transmitting or receiving) information. A message may include a machine readable aggregation of information such as an XML document, fixed field message, comma separated message, or the like. A message may, in some implementations, include a signal utilized to transmit one or more representations of the information. While recited in the singular, it will be understood that a message may be composed, transmitted, stored, received, etc. in multiple parts.
- As used herein a “user interface” (also referred to as an interactive user interface, a graphical user interface or a UI) may refer to a network based interface including data fields and/or other controls for receiving input signals or providing electronic information and/or for providing information to the user in response to any received input signals. A UI may be implemented in whole or in part using technologies such as hyper-text mark-up language (HTML), Flash, Java, .net, web services, and rich site summary (RSS). In some implementations, a UI may be included in a stand-alone client (for example, thick client, fat client) configured to communicate (e.g., send or receive data) in accordance with one or more of the aspects described.
- As used herein a “transmit-receive point” (TRP) (which can alternatively be referred to as a transmission reception point) may refer to a transceiver device or one transceiver element included in a device. When included as a transceiver element, the device may include multiple TRPs. The TRP may include one or more antennas which are coupled to signal processing circuitry. The signal processing circuitry may be included in the device. The TRP may include additional elements to facilitate transmission or receipt of wireless signals for one or more UEs. Example of such elements may include a power source, amplifier, digital-to-analog converter, analog-to-digital converter, or the like. When a TRP is allocated, such as by a BBU, to provide service to a UE, the TRP may be said to be a “serving node” for the UE.
- As used herein a “remote radio unit” (RRU) may refer to a device for controlling and coordinating transmission and receipt of wireless signals for one or more UEs. An RRU may include or be coupled with one or more TRPs. The RRU may receive signals from the TRP and include the signal processing circuitry. The signal processing circuitry may be selectively operated to facilitate processing of signals associated with different TRPs.
- While the above detailed description has shown, described, and pointed out novel features as applied to various embodiments, it can be understood that various omissions, substitutions, and changes in the form and details of the devices or algorithms illustrated can be made without departing from the spirit of the disclosure. For example, circuit blocks and/or method blocks described herein may be deleted, moved, added, subdivided, combined, arranged in a different order, and/or modified. Each of these blocks may be implemented in a variety of different ways. Any portion of any of the methods disclosed herein can be performed in association with specific instructions stored on a non-transitory computer readable storage medium being executed by one or more processors. As can be recognized, certain embodiments described herein can be embodied within a form that does not provide all of the features and benefits set forth herein, as some features can be used or practiced separately from others. The scope of certain embodiments disclosed herein is indicated by the appended claims rather than by the foregoing description. All changes which come within the meaning and range of equivalency of the claims are to be embraced within their scope.
Claims (20)
Priority Applications (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US17/230,783 US12088499B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2021-04-14 | System and method for reducing data packet processing false alarms |
US18/759,545 US20240356848A1 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-06-28 | Latency-reducing wireless network multipoint association |
Applications Claiming Priority (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US202063010500P | 2020-04-15 | 2020-04-15 | |
US17/230,783 US12088499B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2021-04-14 | System and method for reducing data packet processing false alarms |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US18/759,545 Continuation US20240356848A1 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-06-28 | Latency-reducing wireless network multipoint association |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20210329486A1 true US20210329486A1 (en) | 2021-10-21 |
US12088499B2 US12088499B2 (en) | 2024-09-10 |
Family
ID=78080965
Family Applications (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US17/230,783 Active 2041-09-06 US12088499B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2021-04-14 | System and method for reducing data packet processing false alarms |
US17/230,805 Active 2041-10-10 US12068953B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2021-04-14 | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity |
US18/759,545 Pending US20240356848A1 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-06-28 | Latency-reducing wireless network multipoint association |
Family Applications After (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US17/230,805 Active 2041-10-10 US12068953B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2021-04-14 | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity |
US18/759,545 Pending US20240356848A1 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-06-28 | Latency-reducing wireless network multipoint association |
Country Status (8)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (3) | US12088499B2 (en) |
EP (1) | EP4136873A4 (en) |
KR (1) | KR20230008750A (en) |
CN (1) | CN115428513A (en) |
AU (1) | AU2021256985A1 (en) |
CA (1) | CA3175361A1 (en) |
TW (1) | TW202145736A (en) |
WO (1) | WO2021211702A1 (en) |
Cited By (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US11395135B2 (en) * | 2020-12-04 | 2022-07-19 | Ultralogic 6G, Llc | Rapid multi-hop message transfer in 5G and 6G |
US11515973B2 (en) | 2020-05-26 | 2022-11-29 | XCOM Labs, Inc. | Interference-aware beamforming |
US20230284316A1 (en) * | 2017-12-15 | 2023-09-07 | Google Llc | Establishing and Terminating Wireless Links |
US12068953B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-08-20 | Virewirx, Inc. | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity |
Citations (46)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20070230357A1 (en) * | 2006-03-31 | 2007-10-04 | Nortel Networks Limited | Loop detection in a communications network |
US20090016250A1 (en) * | 2007-07-10 | 2009-01-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coding methods of communicating identifiers in peer discovery in a peer-to-peer network |
US20090116420A1 (en) * | 2007-11-02 | 2009-05-07 | Docomo Communications Laboratories Usa, Inc. | Synchronized multi-link transmission in an arq-enabled multi-hop wireless network |
US20110202610A1 (en) * | 2010-02-15 | 2011-08-18 | Damaka, Inc. | System and method for signaling and data tunneling in a peer-to-peer environment |
US20120320932A1 (en) * | 2011-06-20 | 2012-12-20 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Data frame for plc having destination address in the phy header |
US20130294461A1 (en) * | 2010-11-13 | 2013-11-07 | Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. | CGN Entity Based Data Transmission Method, CGN Entity, Gateway, and System |
US20130301611A1 (en) * | 2012-05-10 | 2013-11-14 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and system for connectionless transmission during uplink and downlink of data packets |
US8693344B1 (en) * | 2011-09-27 | 2014-04-08 | Big Switch Network, Inc. | Systems and methods for generating packet forwarding rules based on network policy |
US20140126580A1 (en) * | 2012-11-02 | 2014-05-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method, device, and apparatus for error detection and correction in wireless communications |
US20140280969A1 (en) * | 2013-03-15 | 2014-09-18 | Conrad N. Wood | Load Balancer and Related Techniques |
US20150071171A1 (en) * | 2013-08-26 | 2015-03-12 | Nec Corporation | Communication device and method in a communication system, and device and method for communication path control |
US9237546B1 (en) * | 2013-10-30 | 2016-01-12 | Marvell International Ltd. | Method and apparatus for determining a location of a network device in a wireless network |
US20160014714A1 (en) * | 2014-07-09 | 2016-01-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Traffic advertisement and scheduling in a neighbor aware network data link |
US20160087779A1 (en) * | 2014-04-08 | 2016-03-24 | Empire Technology Development Llc | Full duplex radio communication |
US20160156392A1 (en) * | 2014-12-01 | 2016-06-02 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for communicating data between station and neighbor access point in communication system |
US20160212678A1 (en) * | 2013-08-26 | 2016-07-21 | Nec Corporation | Communication apparatus and method, communication path control apparatus and method in a communication system |
US20160248542A1 (en) * | 2013-11-06 | 2016-08-25 | Mediatek Singapore Pte. Ltd. | Reception Failure Feedback Scheme in Wireless Local Area Networks |
US20160269355A1 (en) * | 2013-10-14 | 2016-09-15 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and device for setting selective source ip address |
US20160277961A1 (en) * | 2014-09-12 | 2016-09-22 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Methods and systems for controlling congestion in a communication network |
US20160277929A1 (en) * | 2013-10-25 | 2016-09-22 | Hangzhou H3C Technologies Co., Ltd. | Network access control |
US20160344766A1 (en) * | 2015-05-19 | 2016-11-24 | Ford Global Technologies, Llc | Spoofing detection |
US20170034847A1 (en) * | 2015-07-31 | 2017-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for multi-channel medium access control protocol |
US20170180025A1 (en) * | 2015-12-21 | 2017-06-22 | Laurent Cariou | Techniques for passive beamforming training |
US20170273080A1 (en) * | 2014-09-24 | 2017-09-21 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for communication between devices in wireless communication system |
US20180004528A1 (en) * | 2016-06-30 | 2018-01-04 | Fujitsu Limited | Arithmetic processing device and control method of arithmetic processing device |
US20180145919A1 (en) * | 2016-11-23 | 2018-05-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Wi-fi link aggregation |
US10015087B1 (en) * | 2015-12-17 | 2018-07-03 | Rockwell Collins, Inc. | Modem hardware abstraction layer (MHAL) on-chip bus packet router |
US20180234163A1 (en) * | 2015-08-13 | 2018-08-16 | Ntt Docomo, Inc. | Relay device and relay method |
US20180278624A1 (en) * | 2017-03-27 | 2018-09-27 | Zenedge, Inc. | Protection Configuration for Application Programming Interfaces |
US20180338265A1 (en) * | 2017-05-16 | 2018-11-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Ethernet over cellular |
US20190052327A1 (en) * | 2016-04-15 | 2019-02-14 | Panasonic Intellectual Property Corporation Of America | Communication apparatus and communication method |
US20190349926A1 (en) * | 2017-02-01 | 2019-11-14 | Nokia Technologies Oy | Determining access slot for communications on radio interface |
US20190350025A1 (en) * | 2016-09-30 | 2019-11-14 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Network Assistance via a Local Breakout Function-Gateway in RAN |
US20200275425A1 (en) * | 2019-02-22 | 2020-08-27 | Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for sidelink transmission and resource allocation |
US20200344684A1 (en) * | 2018-01-15 | 2020-10-29 | Nokia Technologies Oy | Power saving for wireless device |
US20200367170A1 (en) * | 2017-12-14 | 2020-11-19 | Panasonic Intellectual Property Corporation Of America | Communication apparatus and communication method |
US20200383156A1 (en) * | 2019-06-03 | 2020-12-03 | Mediatek Singapore Pte. Ltd. | Systems and methods for constrained multi-link operation in a wireless network |
US20210076329A1 (en) * | 2017-12-22 | 2021-03-11 | Nokia Technologies Oy | Distance aware wake-up radio operation |
US20210127296A1 (en) * | 2019-10-25 | 2021-04-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reducing feedback latency for network coding in wireless backhaul communications networks |
US20210167907A1 (en) * | 2018-11-28 | 2021-06-03 | Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. | Interference Source Identification Method, Related Device, and Computer Storage Medium |
US11070467B1 (en) * | 2019-05-24 | 2021-07-20 | Amazon Technologies, Inc. | Expedited route recovery and load balancing in a multi-radio mesh network |
US20210321485A1 (en) * | 2020-04-09 | 2021-10-14 | Realtek Semiconductor Corp. | Mesh network system |
US20210328920A1 (en) * | 2020-04-15 | 2021-10-21 | XCOM Labs, Inc. | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity |
US20210352663A1 (en) * | 2020-05-08 | 2021-11-11 | Charter Communications Operating, Llc | Methods and apparatus for supporting prioritized transmission opportunity (txop) sharing |
US20210376973A1 (en) * | 2020-05-26 | 2021-12-02 | XCOM Labs, Inc. | Interference-aware beamforming |
US20220107677A1 (en) * | 2019-11-01 | 2022-04-07 | Tencent Technology (Shenzhen) Company Limited | Data receiving and transmitting method and apparatus, computer device, and storage medium |
Family Cites Families (652)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US170026A (en) | 1875-11-16 | Improvement in tools for bending bale-hooks | ||
ZA95605B (en) | 1994-04-28 | 1995-12-20 | Qualcomm Inc | Method and apparatus for automatic gain control and dc offset cancellation in quadrature receiver |
US5469115A (en) | 1994-04-28 | 1995-11-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for automatic gain control in a digital receiver |
TW294867B (en) | 1994-12-23 | 1997-01-01 | Qualcomm Inc | |
US6006108A (en) | 1996-01-31 | 1999-12-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Digital audio processing in a dual-mode telephone |
FI102654B (en) * | 1996-02-22 | 1999-01-15 | Nokia Mobile Phones Ltd | Method of replacing base station in a radio extension of the ATM network |
US5870431A (en) | 1996-06-27 | 1999-02-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | ROM-based finite impulse response filter for use in mobile telephone |
US7184426B2 (en) | 2002-12-12 | 2007-02-27 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for burst pilot for a time division multiplex system |
US7289473B1 (en) | 1997-11-03 | 2007-10-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot reference transmission for a wireless communication system |
US6574211B2 (en) | 1997-11-03 | 2003-06-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for high rate packet data transmission |
US9118387B2 (en) | 1997-11-03 | 2015-08-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot reference transmission for a wireless communication system |
US6894994B1 (en) | 1997-11-03 | 2005-05-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | High data rate wireless packet data communications system |
US6134440A (en) | 1998-01-26 | 2000-10-17 | Qualcomm Inc. | Method and apparatus for performing mobile station assisted hard handoff using off line searching |
US6147964A (en) | 1998-05-07 | 2000-11-14 | Qualcomm Inc. | Method and apparatus for performing rate determination using orthogonal rate-dependent walsh covering codes |
US6107878A (en) | 1998-08-06 | 2000-08-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Automatic gain control circuit for controlling multiple variable gain amplifier stages while estimating received signal power |
US6798736B1 (en) | 1998-09-22 | 2004-09-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for transmitting and receiving variable rate data |
US6208873B1 (en) | 1998-11-23 | 2001-03-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for transmitting reverse link power control signals based on the probability that the power control command is in error |
US6205129B1 (en) | 1999-01-15 | 2001-03-20 | Qualcomm Inc. | Method and apparatus for variable and fixed forward link rate control in a mobile radio communications system |
US6434376B1 (en) | 1999-02-12 | 2002-08-13 | Qualcomm, Inc. | Slotted idle mode for dual mode subscriber stations |
WO2000054430A1 (en) | 1999-03-12 | 2000-09-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for power allocation on a reverse link power control channel of a communication system |
US6363102B1 (en) | 1999-04-23 | 2002-03-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for frequency offset correction |
US8050198B2 (en) | 1999-05-24 | 2011-11-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and system for scheduling data transmission in communication systems |
US7155246B2 (en) | 1999-06-30 | 2006-12-26 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Transmitter directed code division multiple access system using multi-users diversity to maximize throughput while equitably providing access to users |
US6449490B1 (en) | 1999-05-24 | 2002-09-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmitter directed code division multiple access system using path diversity to equitably maximize throughput |
US6466558B1 (en) | 1999-06-14 | 2002-10-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Selection mechanism for signal combining methods |
US6285861B1 (en) | 1999-06-14 | 2001-09-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Receiving station with interference signal suppression |
US6397070B1 (en) | 1999-07-21 | 2002-05-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for estimating reverse link loading in a wireless communication system |
US6633552B1 (en) | 1999-08-06 | 2003-10-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for determining the closed loop power control set point in a wireless packet data communication system |
US6426971B1 (en) | 1999-09-13 | 2002-07-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | System and method for accurately predicting signal to interference and noise ratio to improve communications system performance |
TW498664B (en) | 1999-09-17 | 2002-08-11 | Qualcomm Inc | Method and apparatus for rotating a phase of a modulated signal |
US7206580B2 (en) | 1999-11-04 | 2007-04-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for performing handoff in a high speed communication system |
US6661833B1 (en) | 2000-01-31 | 2003-12-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | PN generators for spread spectrum communications systems |
US6694469B1 (en) | 2000-04-14 | 2004-02-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and an apparatus for a quick retransmission of signals in a communication system |
US7088701B1 (en) | 2000-04-14 | 2006-08-08 | Qualcomm, Inc. | Method and apparatus for adaptive transmission control in a high data rate communication system |
US6678257B1 (en) | 2000-09-25 | 2004-01-13 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for allocation of power to base station channels |
US7051268B1 (en) | 2000-09-29 | 2006-05-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for reducing power consumption of a decoder in a communication system |
US6985516B1 (en) | 2000-11-27 | 2006-01-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for processing a received signal in a communications system |
US6693920B2 (en) | 2000-12-14 | 2004-02-17 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and an apparatus for a waveform quality measurement |
US6714526B2 (en) | 2000-12-15 | 2004-03-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for code assignment in a spread spectrum wireless communication system |
US7010073B2 (en) | 2001-01-19 | 2006-03-07 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Delay lock loops for wireless communication systems |
US7020225B2 (en) | 2001-01-19 | 2006-03-28 | Qualcomm Inc. | Frequency searcher and frequency-locked data demodulator using a programmable rotator |
US6813478B2 (en) | 2001-02-12 | 2004-11-02 | Qualcomm Inc | Method and apparatus for searching a gated pilot |
US7068707B2 (en) | 2001-03-08 | 2006-06-27 | Qualcomm, Inc. | Method and apparatus for tracking signals in a wireless communication system |
US6680968B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2004-01-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | CDMA searcher with time offset compensation |
US6987778B2 (en) | 2001-05-22 | 2006-01-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced channel interleaving for optimized data throughput |
WO2003001838A1 (en) | 2001-06-26 | 2003-01-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for adaptive server selection in a data communication system |
US6757520B2 (en) | 2001-06-26 | 2004-06-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for selecting a serving sector in a data communication system |
US7251229B2 (en) | 2001-08-06 | 2007-07-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and techniques for measuring relative power |
US7596090B2 (en) | 2001-10-04 | 2009-09-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Capacity-efficient flow control mechanism |
US6680925B2 (en) | 2001-10-16 | 2004-01-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and system for selecting a best serving sector in a CDMA data communication system |
US7012883B2 (en) | 2001-11-21 | 2006-03-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Rate selection for an OFDM system |
US6594501B2 (en) | 2001-12-14 | 2003-07-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and techniques for channel gain computations |
US7133437B2 (en) | 2002-01-31 | 2006-11-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot interpolation for a gated pilot with compensation for induced phase changes |
US6738608B2 (en) | 2002-02-12 | 2004-05-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frequency-timing control loop for wireless communication systems |
US6636568B2 (en) | 2002-03-01 | 2003-10-21 | Qualcomm | Data transmission with non-uniform distribution of data rates for a multiple-input multiple-output (MIMO) system |
US7209517B2 (en) | 2002-03-04 | 2007-04-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for estimating a maximum rate of data and for estimating power required for transmission of data at a rate of data in a communication system |
US6748201B2 (en) | 2002-03-28 | 2004-06-08 | Qualcomm Inc. | Gain control for communications device |
US7072628B2 (en) | 2002-04-05 | 2006-07-04 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for determining receive diversity in mobile station |
US6801580B2 (en) | 2002-04-09 | 2004-10-05 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Ordered successive interference cancellation receiver processing for multipath channels |
US7266156B2 (en) | 2002-04-26 | 2007-09-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for reducing peak to average power ratio of a multi-carrier signal |
US6920504B2 (en) | 2002-05-13 | 2005-07-19 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for controlling flow of data in a communication system |
US7184713B2 (en) | 2002-06-20 | 2007-02-27 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Rate control for multi-channel communication systems |
US7239622B2 (en) | 2002-09-19 | 2007-07-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Modified scheduling technique for a telecommunication system |
US7130282B2 (en) | 2002-09-20 | 2006-10-31 | Qualcomm Inc | Communication device for providing multimedia in a group communication network |
US8411594B2 (en) | 2002-09-20 | 2013-04-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Communication manager for providing multimedia in a group communication network |
US8165619B2 (en) | 2002-10-02 | 2012-04-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Power allocation for power control bits in a cellular network |
US20040121730A1 (en) | 2002-10-16 | 2004-06-24 | Tamer Kadous | Transmission scheme for multi-carrier MIMO systems |
US6873606B2 (en) | 2002-10-16 | 2005-03-29 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Rate adaptive transmission scheme for MIMO systems |
US8213390B2 (en) | 2002-10-24 | 2012-07-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reverse link automatic repeat request |
US7042857B2 (en) | 2002-10-29 | 2006-05-09 | Qualcom, Incorporated | Uplink pilot and signaling transmission in wireless communication systems |
US7039001B2 (en) | 2002-10-29 | 2006-05-02 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Channel estimation for OFDM communication systems |
US6928062B2 (en) | 2002-10-29 | 2005-08-09 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Uplink pilot and signaling transmission in wireless communication systems |
US7295857B2 (en) | 2002-10-30 | 2007-11-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for performing acquisition in power save mode for wireless communication systems |
US7236535B2 (en) | 2002-11-19 | 2007-06-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reduced complexity channel estimation for wireless communication systems |
US7564818B2 (en) | 2002-11-26 | 2009-07-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reverse link automatic repeat request |
DE10258860A1 (en) | 2002-12-17 | 2004-07-15 | Robert Bosch Gmbh | Magnetoresistive layer system and sensor element with this layer system |
US7719991B2 (en) | 2003-01-21 | 2010-05-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reverse rate indicator detection |
US7995684B2 (en) | 2003-02-01 | 2011-08-09 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for automatic gain control of a multi-carrier signal in a communication receiver |
US7450943B2 (en) | 2003-02-12 | 2008-11-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for determining coverage and switching between overlay communication systems |
US7095790B2 (en) | 2003-02-25 | 2006-08-22 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Transmission schemes for multi-antenna communication systems utilizing multi-carrier modulation |
US7369549B2 (en) | 2003-03-25 | 2008-05-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Adaptive rate prioritizing |
US7069037B2 (en) | 2003-04-11 | 2006-06-27 | Qualcomm, Inc. | System and method for fluid power control of a reverse link communication |
US7646802B2 (en) | 2003-06-02 | 2010-01-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Communication receiver with hybrid equalizer |
US7376209B2 (en) | 2003-06-06 | 2008-05-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for near-optimal scaling of log-likelihood ratio (LLR) computation in turbo decoding for hybrid automatic repeat request (ARQ) |
US7525909B2 (en) | 2003-06-19 | 2009-04-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for dynamic adjustment of rise-over-thermal (ROT) threshold for reverse link rate allocation |
US8908496B2 (en) | 2003-09-09 | 2014-12-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Incremental redundancy transmission in a MIMO communication system |
US7668125B2 (en) | 2003-09-09 | 2010-02-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Incremental redundancy transmission for multiple parallel channels in a MIMO communication system |
US6917821B2 (en) | 2003-09-23 | 2005-07-12 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Successive interference cancellation receiver processing with selection diversity |
US7508748B2 (en) | 2003-10-24 | 2009-03-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Rate selection for a multi-carrier MIMO system |
US7145940B2 (en) | 2003-12-05 | 2006-12-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot transmission schemes for a multi-antenna system |
US7411930B2 (en) | 2003-12-17 | 2008-08-12 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Apparatus and method for prioritized apportionment of transmission power in a multi-carrier terminal |
US8391413B2 (en) | 2003-12-19 | 2013-03-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel estimation for an OFDM communication system with inactive subbands |
KR101129205B1 (en) | 2004-01-20 | 2012-03-27 | 퀄컴 인코포레이티드 | Synchronized broadcast/multicast communication |
US8077691B2 (en) | 2004-03-05 | 2011-12-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot transmission and channel estimation for MISO and MIMO receivers in a multi-antenna system |
KR100896399B1 (en) | 2004-05-05 | 2009-05-08 | 콸콤 인코포레이티드 | An apparatus for scheduling transmission instances |
US8331377B2 (en) | 2004-05-05 | 2012-12-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Distributed forward link schedulers for multi-carrier communication systems |
US7149264B2 (en) | 2004-06-14 | 2006-12-12 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | CDMA pilot assisted channel estimation |
US8457152B2 (en) | 2004-07-16 | 2013-06-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multiple modulation schemes in single rate layering wireless communication systems |
US8111663B2 (en) | 2004-07-20 | 2012-02-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and systems for variable rate broadcast with soft handoff |
US7940663B2 (en) | 2004-07-20 | 2011-05-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mitigating ACK/NACK errors in MIMO/SIC/HARQ |
US7567621B2 (en) | 2004-07-21 | 2009-07-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Capacity based rank prediction for MIMO design |
US9148256B2 (en) | 2004-07-21 | 2015-09-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Performance based rank prediction for MIMO design |
US7418046B2 (en) | 2004-07-22 | 2008-08-26 | Qualcomm Inc. | Pilot transmission and channel estimation for multiple transmitters |
EP1787290B1 (en) | 2004-08-30 | 2010-11-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for an adaptive de-jitter buffer |
US7672383B2 (en) | 2004-09-17 | 2010-03-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Noise variance estimation in wireless communications for diversity combining and log-likelihood scaling |
US8085678B2 (en) | 2004-10-13 | 2011-12-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Media (voice) playback (de-jitter) buffer adjustments based on air interface |
US7974359B2 (en) | 2004-12-22 | 2011-07-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for mitigating multi-antenna correlation effect in communication systems |
US7382744B2 (en) | 2005-01-27 | 2008-06-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods for optimizing the allocation of resources to serve different types of data flows in a wireless communication system |
US8102872B2 (en) | 2005-02-01 | 2012-01-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method for discontinuous transmission and accurate reproduction of background noise information |
US20070066232A1 (en) | 2005-09-22 | 2007-03-22 | Black Peter J | Pilot grouping and route protocols in multi-carrier communication systems |
US7848298B2 (en) | 2005-03-08 | 2010-12-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | De-coupling forward and reverse link assignment for multi-carrier wireless communication systems |
US9246560B2 (en) | 2005-03-10 | 2016-01-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods for beamforming and rate control in a multi-input multi-output communication systems |
US20060203794A1 (en) | 2005-03-10 | 2006-09-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods for beamforming in multi-input multi-output communication systems |
US9154211B2 (en) | 2005-03-11 | 2015-10-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods for beamforming feedback in multi antenna communication systems |
US7725799B2 (en) | 2005-03-31 | 2010-05-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Power savings in hierarchically coded modulation |
US9184870B2 (en) | 2005-04-01 | 2015-11-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods for control channel signaling |
US8868118B2 (en) | 2005-04-08 | 2014-10-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multiplexing on the reverse link feedbacks for multiple forward link frequencies |
US7570453B2 (en) | 2005-12-07 | 2009-08-04 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus reducing data damage from mechanical shock in a hard disk drive |
US7609773B2 (en) | 2005-04-18 | 2009-10-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method of determining the location of the FFT window and the delay spread for the platinum broadcast channel estimator |
US9036538B2 (en) | 2005-04-19 | 2015-05-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frequency hopping design for single carrier FDMA systems |
US9408220B2 (en) | 2005-04-19 | 2016-08-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel quality reporting for adaptive sectorization |
US7564775B2 (en) | 2005-04-29 | 2009-07-21 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Timing control in orthogonal frequency division multiplex systems based on effective signal-to-noise ratio |
US8842693B2 (en) | 2005-05-31 | 2014-09-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Rank step-down for MIMO SCW design employing HARQ |
US8462859B2 (en) | 2005-06-01 | 2013-06-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Sphere decoding apparatus |
US8971461B2 (en) | 2005-06-01 | 2015-03-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | CQI and rank prediction for list sphere decoding and ML MIMO receivers |
US7428269B2 (en) | 2005-06-01 | 2008-09-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | CQI and rank prediction for list sphere decoding and ML MIMO receivers |
US9179319B2 (en) | 2005-06-16 | 2015-11-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Adaptive sectorization in cellular systems |
US20070071147A1 (en) | 2005-06-16 | 2007-03-29 | Hemanth Sampath | Pseudo eigen-beamforming with dynamic beam selection |
US8160596B2 (en) | 2005-07-20 | 2012-04-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Asymmetric mode of operation in multi-carrier communication systems |
US8493942B2 (en) | 2005-08-01 | 2013-07-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference cancellation in wireless communication |
ES2349883T3 (en) | 2005-08-16 | 2011-01-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | PROCEDURES AND SYSTEMS FOR ADAPTIVE SERVER SELECTION IN WIRELESS COMMUNICATIONS. |
US20070041457A1 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2007-02-22 | Tamer Kadous | Method and apparatus for providing antenna diversity in a wireless communication system |
US8077654B2 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2011-12-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Auxiliary FL MIMO pilot transmission in 1XEV-DO |
US8611305B2 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2013-12-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference cancellation for wireless communications |
US8743909B2 (en) | 2008-02-20 | 2014-06-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frame termination |
US8594252B2 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2013-11-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference cancellation for wireless communications |
US8073068B2 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2011-12-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Selective virtual antenna transmission |
US9014152B2 (en) | 2008-06-09 | 2015-04-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Increasing capacity in wireless communications |
US8630602B2 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2014-01-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot interference cancellation |
US9071344B2 (en) | 2005-08-22 | 2015-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reverse link interference cancellation |
US8094595B2 (en) | 2005-08-26 | 2012-01-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for packet communications in wireless systems |
US9136974B2 (en) | 2005-08-30 | 2015-09-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Precoding and SDMA support |
US8139672B2 (en) | 2005-09-23 | 2012-03-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for pilot communication in a multi-antenna wireless communication system |
US8385433B2 (en) | 2005-10-27 | 2013-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Linear precoding for spatially correlated channels |
US7948959B2 (en) | 2005-10-27 | 2011-05-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Linear precoding for time division duplex system |
US9172453B2 (en) | 2005-10-27 | 2015-10-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for pre-coding frequency division duplexing system |
DK1941647T3 (en) | 2005-10-27 | 2013-08-26 | Qualcomm Inc | Pre-coding for segment-sensitive scheduling in wireless communication systems |
EP1941638A2 (en) | 2005-10-27 | 2008-07-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for estimating reverse link loading in a wireless communication system |
US20070165738A1 (en) | 2005-10-27 | 2007-07-19 | Barriac Gwendolyn D | Method and apparatus for pre-coding for a mimo system |
US8760994B2 (en) | 2005-10-28 | 2014-06-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Unitary precoding based on randomized FFT matrices |
US7924753B2 (en) | 2005-11-15 | 2011-04-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and system for decoding |
US8107517B2 (en) | 2005-12-09 | 2012-01-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Average-tap energy based thresholding for channel estimation in multi antenna systems |
US7729714B2 (en) | 2005-12-20 | 2010-06-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for reverse link transmit beam-forming |
US7893873B2 (en) | 2005-12-20 | 2011-02-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and systems for providing enhanced position location in wireless communications |
US8472424B2 (en) | 2006-02-21 | 2013-06-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for supporting multiple multiplexing schemes for wireless communication |
US9461736B2 (en) | 2006-02-21 | 2016-10-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for sub-slot packets in wireless communication |
US8676209B2 (en) | 2006-06-13 | 2014-03-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Handoff selection for wireless communication systems |
WO2007146891A2 (en) | 2006-06-13 | 2007-12-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Power control for wireless communication systems |
KR101061624B1 (en) | 2006-06-13 | 2011-09-01 | 콸콤 인코포레이티드 | Reverse link pilot transmission for wireless communication system |
US20070291681A1 (en) | 2006-06-16 | 2007-12-20 | Nokia Corporation | Method and apparatus for providing information about each group address that has data waiting for delivery in node, point or terminal in a WLAN |
US20080025241A1 (en) | 2006-07-28 | 2008-01-31 | Naga Bhushan | Method and apparatus for broadcast multicast service in an ultra mobile broadband network |
US8014331B2 (en) | 2006-07-28 | 2011-09-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for using a MAC protocol for broadcast |
US8229423B2 (en) | 2006-08-22 | 2012-07-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Broadcast and multicast services in wireless communication systems |
US8457221B2 (en) | 2006-09-08 | 2013-06-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Signaling transmission with localized spreading for wireless communication |
US7903615B2 (en) | 2006-10-10 | 2011-03-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Space division multiple access channelization in wireless communication systems |
CA2667204C (en) | 2006-10-24 | 2013-09-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Acknowledgement channel for wireless communications |
US8391196B2 (en) | 2006-10-26 | 2013-03-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic power amplifier backoff using headroom information |
US8885744B2 (en) | 2006-11-10 | 2014-11-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Providing antenna diversity in a wireless communication system |
US8611303B2 (en) | 2007-02-02 | 2013-12-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Seamless context switching for radio link protocol |
US8412227B2 (en) | 2007-05-18 | 2013-04-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Positioning using enhanced pilot signal |
US8514988B2 (en) | 2007-05-18 | 2013-08-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced pilot signal receiver |
US8909279B2 (en) | 2007-08-10 | 2014-12-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Adaptation of transmit power for neighboring nodes |
US20090080499A1 (en) | 2007-09-21 | 2009-03-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management employing fractional code reuse |
US9374791B2 (en) | 2007-09-21 | 2016-06-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management utilizing power and attenuation profiles |
US9137806B2 (en) | 2007-09-21 | 2015-09-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management employing fractional time reuse |
US9066306B2 (en) | 2007-09-21 | 2015-06-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management utilizing power control |
US8824979B2 (en) | 2007-09-21 | 2014-09-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management employing fractional frequency reuse |
US9078269B2 (en) | 2007-09-21 | 2015-07-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management utilizing HARQ interlaces |
US8867456B2 (en) | 2007-11-27 | 2014-10-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interface management in wireless communication system using hybrid time reuse |
US8948095B2 (en) | 2007-11-27 | 2015-02-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management in a wireless communication system using frequency selective transmission |
US8320358B2 (en) * | 2007-12-12 | 2012-11-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for resolving blinded-node problems in wireless networks |
US8042086B2 (en) | 2007-12-21 | 2011-10-18 | Oracle America, Inc. | Method and apparatus for verifying integrated circuit design using a constrained random test bench |
US8483223B2 (en) | 2008-02-01 | 2013-07-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Packet transmission via multiple links in a wireless communication system |
US8331892B2 (en) | 2008-03-29 | 2012-12-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and system for DC compensation and AGC |
US8385465B2 (en) | 2008-03-29 | 2013-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmitter chain timing and transmit power control |
US8451740B2 (en) | 2008-04-01 | 2013-05-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Compensating for drifts occurring during sleep times in access terminals |
US7792111B2 (en) * | 2008-04-23 | 2010-09-07 | Cisco Technology, Inc. | Point-to-multipoint for multicast and unicast forwarding |
EP2279595A4 (en) | 2008-05-09 | 2014-06-11 | Lg Electronics Inc | Device and method for multicast in wireless local access network |
US8583137B2 (en) | 2008-05-16 | 2013-11-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic coverage adjustment in a multi-carrier communication system |
US8605801B2 (en) | 2008-05-20 | 2013-12-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot signal set management in a multi-carrier communication system |
US8375261B2 (en) | 2008-07-07 | 2013-02-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | System and method of puncturing pulses in a receiver or transmitter |
US8340605B2 (en) | 2008-08-06 | 2012-12-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coordinated transmissions between cells of a base station in a wireless communications system |
US9755705B2 (en) | 2008-08-07 | 2017-09-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for supporting multi-user and single-user MIMO in a wireless communication system |
US8203961B2 (en) | 2008-08-11 | 2012-06-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for providing modified timestamps in a communication system |
US10028332B2 (en) | 2008-08-15 | 2018-07-17 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Hierarchical clustering framework for inter-cell MIMO systems |
US9521554B2 (en) | 2008-08-15 | 2016-12-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Adaptive clustering framework in frequency-time for network MIMO systems |
US8331310B2 (en) | 2008-08-22 | 2012-12-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods employing multiple input multiple output (MIMO) techniques |
US8498647B2 (en) | 2008-08-28 | 2013-07-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Distributed downlink coordinated multi-point (CoMP) framework |
US20100067422A1 (en) | 2008-09-12 | 2010-03-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and methods for controlling a sleep mode in a wireless device |
US8576760B2 (en) | 2008-09-12 | 2013-11-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and methods for controlling an idle mode in a wireless device |
US8971884B2 (en) | 2008-09-30 | 2015-03-03 | At&T Mobility Ii Llc | Rejection notification to a universal integrated circuit card |
US8611325B2 (en) | 2008-10-01 | 2013-12-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for plug-and-play venue-cast co-channel with wide-area network |
US8432821B2 (en) | 2008-10-02 | 2013-04-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for cooperation strategy selection in a wireless communication system |
US8654715B2 (en) | 2008-10-24 | 2014-02-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods providing mobile transmit diversity |
US8654705B2 (en) | 2008-10-24 | 2014-02-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | System and method for supporting multiple reverse link data streams |
US8175594B2 (en) | 2008-10-24 | 2012-05-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Active set management with hotspot carriers |
US8923125B2 (en) | 2008-10-24 | 2014-12-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Wireless network resource adaptation |
US8634438B2 (en) | 2008-12-01 | 2014-01-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Wireless communication systems with femto nodes |
US8675511B2 (en) | 2008-12-10 | 2014-03-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | List elimination for distributed downlink coordinated multi-point (CoMP) framework |
US10812937B2 (en) | 2008-12-11 | 2020-10-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for obtaining contextually relevant content |
US8787183B2 (en) | 2009-01-06 | 2014-07-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for channel estimation using multiple description codes |
US8854944B2 (en) | 2009-01-17 | 2014-10-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for interference cancellation |
US8494593B2 (en) | 2009-01-23 | 2013-07-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and system for wireless coverage redundancy |
US8358969B2 (en) | 2009-05-11 | 2013-01-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Feedback delay control in an echo cancellation repeater |
US20130336193A1 (en) | 2012-06-19 | 2013-12-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Network information for assisting user equipment |
US8306096B2 (en) | 2009-06-26 | 2012-11-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference reduction using variable digital-to-analog converter (DAC) sampling rates |
US9185718B2 (en) | 2009-06-29 | 2015-11-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Centralized coexistence manager for controlling operation of multiple radios |
US9161232B2 (en) | 2009-06-29 | 2015-10-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Decentralized coexistence manager for controlling operation of multiple radios |
US8351456B2 (en) | 2009-06-29 | 2013-01-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for radio filtering in a multi-radio device |
US8886126B2 (en) | 2009-07-09 | 2014-11-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Resolution algorithms for multi-radio coexistence |
US20110007688A1 (en) | 2009-07-09 | 2011-01-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for event prioritization and arbitration in a multi-radio device |
US20110007680A1 (en) | 2009-07-09 | 2011-01-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Sleep mode design for coexistence manager |
US8605729B2 (en) | 2009-07-09 | 2013-12-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for OIS protection in a wireless communication system |
US8379705B2 (en) | 2009-08-04 | 2013-02-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Hierarchical feedback of channel state information for wireless communication |
US8588801B2 (en) | 2009-08-21 | 2013-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-point equalization framework for coordinated multi-point transmission |
US8781005B2 (en) | 2009-10-01 | 2014-07-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Scalable quantization of channel state information for MIMO transmission |
US9961579B2 (en) | 2009-10-01 | 2018-05-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Scalable channel feedback for wireless communication |
US10389479B2 (en) | 2010-01-29 | 2019-08-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for signaling expansion and backward compatibility preservation in wireless communication systems |
US8614981B2 (en) | 2010-01-29 | 2013-12-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reporting of channel information to support coordinated multi-point data transmission |
US20120026940A1 (en) | 2010-02-02 | 2012-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio reporting set and backhaul reporting set construction for coordinated multi-point communication |
US8634435B2 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2014-01-21 | Qualcomm Incorporation | Short term policy creation and execution of policy executed between communication events of a radio access technology within a coexistence manager hardware/software implementation |
US20120113906A1 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2012-05-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US8825860B2 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2014-09-02 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate voice activity detection and coexistence manager decisions |
US20120077532A1 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2012-03-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US9161233B2 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2015-10-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US8848607B2 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2014-09-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US8724545B2 (en) | 2010-03-31 | 2014-05-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US9282462B2 (en) | 2010-03-31 | 2016-03-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US10911961B2 (en) | 2010-03-31 | 2021-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US9485069B2 (en) | 2010-04-15 | 2016-11-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission and reception of proximity detection signal for peer discovery |
US8812657B2 (en) | 2010-04-15 | 2014-08-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Network-assisted peer discovery |
US8526347B2 (en) | 2010-06-10 | 2013-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Peer-to-peer communication with symmetric waveform for downlink and uplink |
US20110310858A1 (en) | 2010-06-16 | 2011-12-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beacon signaling method and apparatus |
US10250678B2 (en) | 2010-07-07 | 2019-04-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Hybrid modes for peer discovery |
US9136953B2 (en) | 2010-08-03 | 2015-09-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference estimation for wireless communication |
US9185720B2 (en) | 2010-08-04 | 2015-11-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US9277564B2 (en) | 2010-08-05 | 2016-03-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US8923208B2 (en) | 2010-08-05 | 2014-12-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence |
US9113488B2 (en) | 2010-08-13 | 2015-08-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence of a broadband radio and a broadcast stream receiver that receives broadcast stream data |
US20120213303A1 (en) | 2010-08-17 | 2012-08-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Compatible subset generation to facilitate multi-radio coexistence |
US8675560B2 (en) | 2010-09-03 | 2014-03-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | UE receiver reference signal processing that utilizes resource partitioning information |
US8886239B2 (en) | 2010-09-21 | 2014-11-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Buffer status report control for creating transmission gaps |
US20150139015A1 (en) | 2010-09-22 | 2015-05-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | LTE Band Avoidance for RF Coexistence Interference |
US8655400B2 (en) | 2010-09-22 | 2014-02-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reduced transmit power for wireless radio coexistence |
US8897220B2 (en) | 2010-09-22 | 2014-11-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence |
US9398602B2 (en) | 2010-09-22 | 2016-07-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence |
US8817924B2 (en) | 2010-09-23 | 2014-08-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Iterative pilot tone cancellation for improved channel estimation and decoding |
US9451480B2 (en) | 2010-09-28 | 2016-09-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for power management in a wireless communication system |
US8576742B2 (en) | 2010-10-06 | 2013-11-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic switching between common reference signal interference cancellation and resource element puncturing in a co-channel heterogeneous network |
US20120127870A1 (en) | 2010-11-23 | 2012-05-24 | Wanlun Zhao | Method and Apparatus for Enabling an Enhanced Frequency Domain Equalizer |
US20120127923A1 (en) | 2010-11-23 | 2012-05-24 | Wanlun Zhao | Method and Apparatus for Enabling a Low Complexity Receiver |
US8830934B2 (en) | 2010-12-10 | 2014-09-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Configurable filter for multi-radio interference mitigation |
US20120182935A1 (en) | 2011-01-14 | 2012-07-19 | Cisco Technology, Inc. | System and method for packet distribution in a vehicular network environment |
US9578649B2 (en) | 2011-01-20 | 2017-02-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus to facilitate support for multi-radio coexistence |
US20120201158A1 (en) | 2011-02-03 | 2012-08-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Peer-to-peer / wan association control and resource coordination for mobile entities using aggregate neighborhood utility metrics |
US9036521B2 (en) * | 2011-03-31 | 2015-05-19 | Broadcom Corporation | Reducing battery power consumption during discontinuous reception and transmission |
US8855000B2 (en) | 2011-04-28 | 2014-10-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference estimation using data traffic power and reference signal power |
US9144084B2 (en) | 2011-06-13 | 2015-09-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence |
US20120314655A1 (en) | 2011-06-13 | 2012-12-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Data transmission and reception with harq and network coding |
US9154179B2 (en) | 2011-06-29 | 2015-10-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Receiver with bypass mode for improved sensitivity |
US9059785B2 (en) | 2011-07-07 | 2015-06-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Fast timing acquisition in cell search |
US9237434B2 (en) | 2011-07-13 | 2016-01-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Network-assisted peer discovery with network coding |
US9497765B2 (en) | 2011-08-17 | 2016-11-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Network coordination for improved interference cancellation |
US9124464B2 (en) | 2011-08-30 | 2015-09-01 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Methods and apparatus for channel estimation in MIMO-OFDM communication system |
US9100227B2 (en) | 2011-08-30 | 2015-08-04 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Methods and apparatus for estimating channel time and frequency correlations in OFDM communication receiver |
US20130058276A1 (en) | 2011-09-07 | 2013-03-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for signaling side information for network coding in a wireless communication network |
US8879445B2 (en) | 2011-10-26 | 2014-11-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mitigating impact of power imbalance on remote data rate in wireless local area network |
US9585156B2 (en) | 2011-11-14 | 2017-02-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Supporting different LTE-TDD configurations in neighboring regions and/or adjacent carriers |
US8897181B2 (en) | 2011-12-15 | 2014-11-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence |
US20130194948A1 (en) | 2012-01-27 | 2013-08-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods for indicating backhaul relay geometry |
US8976662B2 (en) | 2012-02-09 | 2015-03-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and method for opportunistic relay association |
US9143957B2 (en) | 2012-02-24 | 2015-09-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mitigating cross-device interference |
US9172402B2 (en) | 2012-03-02 | 2015-10-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multiple-input and multiple-output carrier aggregation receiver reuse architecture |
US9491755B2 (en) | 2012-03-09 | 2016-11-08 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Methods and apparatus to transmit and receive synchronization signals in a mobile communication system |
US8897188B2 (en) | 2012-03-19 | 2014-11-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for discontinuous reception in user equipment for power savings |
US9265047B2 (en) | 2012-04-04 | 2016-02-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Procedures to activate opportunistic relays |
US8744018B2 (en) | 2012-04-05 | 2014-06-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Early termination schemes for turbo decoding in a wireless communication system |
US9544175B2 (en) * | 2012-04-13 | 2017-01-10 | Lg Electronics Inc. | Method and device for selective decoding of beacon frame in wireless LAN system |
US9973923B2 (en) | 2012-04-18 | 2018-05-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Small cell activation procedure |
US9107056B2 (en) | 2012-04-18 | 2015-08-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Small cell activation procedure |
US9226173B2 (en) | 2012-04-18 | 2015-12-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-radio coexistence |
US8958412B2 (en) | 2012-05-11 | 2015-02-17 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Methods and apparatus for uplink timing alignment in system with large number of antennas |
US9504089B2 (en) * | 2012-05-14 | 2016-11-22 | Broadcom Corporation | System and method for wireless station bridging |
US9867194B2 (en) | 2012-06-12 | 2018-01-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic UE scheduling with shared antenna and carrier aggregation |
US20130336249A1 (en) | 2012-06-15 | 2013-12-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and methods for resource element group based traffic to pilot ratio aided signal processing |
US9210605B2 (en) | 2012-06-29 | 2015-12-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel state information reporting for partially cancelled interference |
US9071315B2 (en) | 2012-06-29 | 2015-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference signal diversity combining for interference cancellation |
US9167597B2 (en) | 2012-07-13 | 2015-10-20 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Methods and apparatus for transmission of uplink sounding reference signals in a communication system with large number of antennas |
US9474051B2 (en) | 2012-07-19 | 2016-10-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Ordering and processing of interfering channels for reduced complexity implementation |
US20140023001A1 (en) | 2012-07-20 | 2014-01-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatuses and methods of detection of interfering cell communication protocol usage |
US20140029456A1 (en) | 2012-07-27 | 2014-01-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | INTERFERENCE ESTIMATION IN THE PRESENCE OF ePDCCH TRANSMISSIONS |
US9253658B2 (en) | 2012-08-01 | 2016-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Management of uncoordinated interference |
US8839079B2 (en) | 2012-08-20 | 2014-09-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatuses for saving power during transport block decoding in UMTS systems |
US20140071894A1 (en) | 2012-09-13 | 2014-03-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Variable block length and superposition coding for hybrid automatic repeat request |
US9270441B2 (en) | 2012-10-24 | 2016-02-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for improving resource usage in communication networks using interference cancelation |
US10841037B2 (en) | 2013-01-22 | 2020-11-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Managing interference in a network |
US20140219243A1 (en) | 2013-02-07 | 2014-08-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and methods of joint transmit power and resource management |
US20140219117A1 (en) | 2013-02-07 | 2014-08-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and method for inter cell interference coordination |
US9204437B2 (en) | 2013-02-27 | 2015-12-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for conditional offload of one or more log-likelihood ratios (LLRs) or decoded bits |
US10182404B2 (en) | 2013-03-06 | 2019-01-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmit power calibration for matching the coverage of different radio technologies on a common radio node |
US20140273884A1 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-09-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Wlan diversity/mimo using shared antenna |
US20140301309A1 (en) | 2013-04-08 | 2014-10-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Low complexity blind detection of transmission parameters of interferers |
US20140334564A1 (en) | 2013-05-09 | 2014-11-13 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd | Method and system for providing low-complexity hybrid precoding in wireless communication systems |
US10979203B2 (en) | 2013-09-04 | 2021-04-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel selection to reduce interference to a wireless local area network from a cellular network |
US10278177B2 (en) | 2013-09-04 | 2019-04-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Opportunistic carrier aggregation framework for efficient LTE operation in unlicensed spectrum |
US20150063150A1 (en) | 2013-09-04 | 2015-03-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Measurement reporting in unlicensed spectrum |
US20150063151A1 (en) | 2013-09-04 | 2015-03-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Opportunistic supplemental downlink in unlicensed spectrum |
US20150085686A1 (en) | 2013-09-26 | 2015-03-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Scheduling based on signal quality measurements |
US10009053B2 (en) | 2013-09-27 | 2018-06-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Measurement and signaling for network assistance to enable data-IC in small cell clusters |
US9450723B2 (en) | 2013-11-01 | 2016-09-20 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Channel estimation for data transmission parameter determination in systems employing an array-of-subarrays transceiver architecture |
US10375711B2 (en) | 2013-11-12 | 2019-08-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods for LTE channel selection in unlicensed bands |
US9924368B2 (en) | 2013-12-11 | 2018-03-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and methods for cellular communications over unused unlicenced spectrum |
US20150163823A1 (en) | 2013-12-11 | 2015-06-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference classification-based carrier sense adaptive transmission (csat) in unlicensed spectrum |
US10772092B2 (en) | 2013-12-23 | 2020-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mixed numerology OFDM design |
US10044438B2 (en) | 2014-02-17 | 2018-08-07 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Carrier sense adaptive transmission (CSAT) measurements in shared spectrum |
US9474075B2 (en) | 2014-03-28 | 2016-10-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Operation mode adaptation based on hardware and channel condition constraints |
US20150282077A1 (en) | 2014-03-28 | 2015-10-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Optimizing resource usage based on channel conditions and power consumption |
US9351307B2 (en) | 2014-03-31 | 2016-05-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | CSI report with different receiver capabilities |
US9750014B2 (en) | 2014-04-22 | 2017-08-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interlaced carrier sense adaptive transmission (CSAT) co-existence in shared spectrum |
US20150319702A1 (en) | 2014-05-02 | 2015-11-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Configuration of uplink open loop power control parameters |
US20150350919A1 (en) | 2014-05-27 | 2015-12-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Adaptation of enhanced inter-cell interference coordination configuration |
US9712218B2 (en) | 2014-07-28 | 2017-07-18 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for facilitating high data rate transmission in the wireless communication |
US9900074B2 (en) | 2014-08-12 | 2018-02-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | CSI request procedure in LTE/LTE-A with unlicensed spectrum |
US10149318B2 (en) | 2014-09-02 | 2018-12-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for transmitting and receiving downlink control information for a set of NOMA downlink transmissions |
US9882623B2 (en) | 2014-09-18 | 2018-01-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dual thread feedback design for non-orthogonal channels |
US11109376B2 (en) | 2014-09-22 | 2021-08-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Structured channel rasters for unlicensed spectrum |
US20160095039A1 (en) | 2014-09-26 | 2016-03-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission puncturing for co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US20160095040A1 (en) | 2014-09-26 | 2016-03-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission power reduction for co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10149293B2 (en) | 2014-10-16 | 2018-12-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission preemption for enhanced component carriers |
US10700830B2 (en) | 2014-10-21 | 2020-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for conveying identification information in a preamble transmission |
US10219292B2 (en) | 2014-10-24 | 2019-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Flexible multiplexing and feedback for variable transmission time intervals |
US10123323B2 (en) | 2014-10-24 | 2018-11-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic uplink/downlink frame structure for enhanced component carriers |
US9693323B2 (en) | 2014-10-27 | 2017-06-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-channel CSI feedback for LTE/LTE-A with unlicensed spectrum |
US9838169B2 (en) | 2014-10-29 | 2017-12-05 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Methods and apparatus using interleaved guard OFDM in wireless communication systems |
US20160128130A1 (en) | 2014-10-31 | 2016-05-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mixed-mode medium access control (mac) on a shared communication medium |
US10021677B2 (en) | 2014-10-31 | 2018-07-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Two-stage PDCCH with DCI flag and DCI format size indicator |
US10143005B2 (en) | 2014-11-07 | 2018-11-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink control resource allocation for dynamic time-division duplex systems |
WO2016074185A1 (en) | 2014-11-13 | 2016-05-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Standalone carrier sense adaptive transmission (csat) in unlicensed spectrum |
US10484135B2 (en) | 2014-12-15 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mitigation of bursty interference |
US9942801B2 (en) | 2014-12-15 | 2018-04-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for reserving a channel of a radio frequency spectrum |
US10085283B2 (en) | 2014-12-31 | 2018-09-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Antenna subset and directional channel access in a shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US9992004B2 (en) | 2015-02-03 | 2018-06-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Code block cluster level HARQ |
US10270579B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2019-04-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Efficient ACK/NACK transmission |
US10893509B2 (en) | 2015-02-11 | 2021-01-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multiple tri-state HARQ processes |
US10136452B2 (en) | 2015-02-24 | 2018-11-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced PRACH for standalone contention based communications including unlicensed spectrum |
US10349313B2 (en) | 2015-03-02 | 2019-07-09 | Corning Optical Communications LLC | Enhanced features for a gateway coordinating multiple small cell radio access networks |
US9585150B2 (en) | 2015-03-20 | 2017-02-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | EPFD coverage for NGSO satellites |
US9893800B2 (en) | 2015-03-20 | 2018-02-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for spectral efficient data transmission in satellite systems |
US9900856B2 (en) | 2015-03-20 | 2018-02-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for time or frequency synchronization in non-geosynchronous satellite communication systems |
US9954668B2 (en) | 2015-03-23 | 2018-04-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Co-existence system synchronization on a shared communication medium |
US9780847B2 (en) | 2015-03-27 | 2017-10-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel feedback design for frequency selective channels |
US11146328B2 (en) | 2015-04-03 | 2021-10-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for avoiding exceeding interference limits for a non-geostationary satellite system |
US9877203B2 (en) | 2015-05-07 | 2018-01-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel feedback reporting for shared frequency spectrum |
US10285117B2 (en) | 2015-05-21 | 2019-05-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for coexistence between enhanced component carrier communications and non-enhanced component carrier communications |
US20160353482A1 (en) | 2015-05-27 | 2016-12-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reservation coordination in a shared communication medium |
US10200904B2 (en) | 2015-06-24 | 2019-02-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for transmitting on multiple carriers of a shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US20160381673A1 (en) | 2015-06-25 | 2016-12-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Memory management for reception of wireless communications |
US9991989B2 (en) | 2015-06-26 | 2018-06-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Soft hybrid automatic repeat request |
US10693574B2 (en) | 2015-07-02 | 2020-06-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for efficient data transmissions in half-duplex communication systems with large propagation delays |
US10341884B2 (en) | 2015-07-07 | 2019-07-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel clearance techniques using shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US10397796B2 (en) | 2015-07-08 | 2019-08-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Over-the-air signaling for an increased reuse factor in a shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US9929835B2 (en) | 2015-07-10 | 2018-03-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for synchronizing and desynchronizing contention for access to a plurality of channels |
US20170026976A1 (en) | 2015-07-20 | 2017-01-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Flexible coding schemes |
US10805000B2 (en) | 2015-07-23 | 2020-10-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for discontinuous transmission in bent-pipe relay in satellite communication systems |
US20170041766A1 (en) | 2015-08-05 | 2017-02-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Media access control segmentation and packet data convergence protocol delivery notification with enhanced component carriers |
US10397754B2 (en) | 2015-08-06 | 2019-08-27 | Qualcomm Incorporation | Packet data convergence protocol reordering with enhanced component carriers |
US10201014B2 (en) | 2015-08-12 | 2019-02-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Contention-based co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10291379B2 (en) | 2015-08-12 | 2019-05-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Contention-based co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10219300B2 (en) | 2015-08-19 | 2019-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced channel reservation for co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10091789B2 (en) | 2015-08-19 | 2018-10-02 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Re-contention-based co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10542541B2 (en) | 2015-08-19 | 2020-01-21 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Re-contention-based co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10356816B2 (en) | 2015-08-19 | 2019-07-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Re-contention-based co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10334546B2 (en) | 2015-08-31 | 2019-06-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization signaling coordination for co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10299284B2 (en) | 2015-08-31 | 2019-05-21 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Inter-access terminal unblocking and enhanced contention for co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10374777B2 (en) | 2015-08-31 | 2019-08-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Control signaling in a shared communication medium |
US9936400B2 (en) | 2015-09-12 | 2018-04-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel selection in a shared communication medium |
US9788361B2 (en) | 2015-09-18 | 2017-10-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Setting transmission parameters in a shared communication medium |
US9525477B1 (en) | 2015-09-24 | 2016-12-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frequency tracking with sparse pilots |
US10257851B2 (en) | 2015-09-24 | 2019-04-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel configuration for co-existence on a shared communication medium |
US10492220B2 (en) | 2015-09-30 | 2019-11-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Opportunistic extended channel uplink grants for ECC |
US10333668B2 (en) | 2015-10-05 | 2019-06-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced component carrier discovery reference signals |
US10044459B2 (en) | 2015-11-04 | 2018-08-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink control signaling on a shared communication medium |
US10292093B2 (en) | 2015-11-10 | 2019-05-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Communicating subframe timing of an access point on a shared communication medium |
US10645679B2 (en) | 2015-11-18 | 2020-05-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Hybrid automatic repeat request (HARQ) payload mapping for short physical uplink control channel (PUCCH) on a shared communication medium |
US10368348B2 (en) | 2015-11-18 | 2019-07-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Physical control channel signaling on a shared communication medium |
US10368372B2 (en) | 2016-01-12 | 2019-07-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Listen-before-talk techniques for uplink transmissions |
US10219252B2 (en) | 2016-01-15 | 2019-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Shortened control channel resource mapping |
US10098140B2 (en) | 2016-01-27 | 2018-10-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation techniques for unlicensed spectrum |
US11296837B2 (en) | 2016-01-28 | 2022-04-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Physical broadcast channel (PBCH) transmission and reception on a shared communication medium |
US10219235B2 (en) | 2016-02-02 | 2019-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Timing synchronization coordination on a shared communication medium |
US10687288B2 (en) | 2016-02-02 | 2020-06-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization across transmitting nodes using shared radio frequency spectrum |
US10485027B2 (en) | 2016-02-02 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink short transmission techniques using contention-based radio frequency spectrum |
WO2017142901A1 (en) | 2016-02-15 | 2017-08-24 | Spidercloud Wireless, Inc. | Methods for centralized channel selection across different cells in a radio access network |
US10638326B2 (en) | 2016-02-19 | 2020-04-28 | Corning Optical Communications LLC | Long term evolution (LTE) system operating in an unlicensed spectral band with active network discovery and optimization of the unlicensed channels |
US10368305B2 (en) | 2016-03-25 | 2019-07-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Automatic network selection for multefire |
US10034269B2 (en) | 2016-04-18 | 2018-07-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced discontinuous reception design for a shared frequency band |
US10616912B2 (en) | 2016-04-22 | 2020-04-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink payload determination and uplink grant indication for multefire |
US10349404B2 (en) | 2016-04-22 | 2019-07-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Discovery reference signal transmission and decoding and measurement techniques in a wireless communication system |
US10631331B2 (en) | 2016-04-22 | 2020-04-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frame structure signaling for multefire |
US20170332338A1 (en) | 2016-05-10 | 2017-11-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization techniques for multiple nodes in a wireless communications system |
US10477526B2 (en) | 2016-06-10 | 2019-11-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink procedures on a shared communication medium |
US10516618B2 (en) | 2016-06-10 | 2019-12-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Preamble design on a shared communication medium |
US10524279B2 (en) | 2016-07-22 | 2019-12-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Joint comp with multiple operators |
US10602545B2 (en) | 2016-07-26 | 2020-03-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Cooperative hidden node identification and management |
US10681733B2 (en) | 2016-07-26 | 2020-06-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | License assisted request-to-send and clear-to-send transmission |
US10631295B2 (en) | 2016-08-02 | 2020-04-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for beacon-assisted multi-tier spectrum sharing |
US10952142B2 (en) | 2016-08-16 | 2021-03-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Energy-efficient paging in wireless networks |
US10887941B2 (en) | 2016-08-18 | 2021-01-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Retaining access to a shared radio frequency spectrum band during an uplink control portion of a transmission structure |
US10405242B2 (en) | 2016-08-19 | 2019-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Robust channel reservation on a shared communication medium |
US10581722B2 (en) | 2016-08-22 | 2020-03-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Power control for independent links |
US20180062801A1 (en) | 2016-08-24 | 2018-03-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for wireless communications in coordinated multi-point operation |
US10536195B2 (en) | 2016-08-26 | 2020-01-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Overlapping cluster architecture for coordinated multipoint (CoMP) |
US10582458B2 (en) | 2016-09-01 | 2020-03-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Listen before talk design for spectrum sharing in new radio (NR) |
US10631173B2 (en) | 2016-09-02 | 2020-04-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio (NR) procedures for shared spectrum |
US10542436B2 (en) | 2016-09-02 | 2020-01-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Unlicensed spectrum operation for narrowband internet of things and enhanced machine type communication |
US10218406B2 (en) | 2016-09-02 | 2019-02-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Narrowband communication for different device capabilities in unlicensed spectrum |
US10834757B2 (en) | 2016-09-15 | 2020-11-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for channel reservation |
US10484878B2 (en) | 2016-09-16 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Mixed-access mode communication for standalone operation on a shared communication medium |
US10542556B2 (en) | 2016-09-23 | 2020-01-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Modulation and coding scheme (MCS) and/or rank selection in coordinated multi-point (CoMP) communication |
US10244399B2 (en) | 2016-09-30 | 2019-03-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Signature sequence-based signaling and allocation of resources of a shared spectrum |
US10257848B2 (en) | 2016-10-04 | 2019-04-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Directional channel reservation for time-division multiplexing downlink and uplink data burst transmission |
US10033558B2 (en) | 2016-10-04 | 2018-07-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Inter-eNB over-the-air calibration for reciprocity-based coordinated multipoint communications |
US10425945B2 (en) | 2016-10-11 | 2019-09-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-stage channel reservation signal for directional transmission and reception |
US10536944B2 (en) | 2016-10-12 | 2020-01-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for contending for access to a radio frequency spectrum band using a coordinated listen before talk procedure |
US11716751B2 (en) | 2016-10-19 | 2023-08-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for new radio frame structures for data transmission |
US10448296B2 (en) | 2016-10-24 | 2019-10-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coding of handover messages between nodes of different radio access technologies |
US10206117B2 (en) | 2016-10-26 | 2019-02-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio shared spectrum access procedures |
US10547494B2 (en) | 2016-10-31 | 2020-01-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Unlicensed spectrum coverage enhancement for industrial internet of things |
US10506629B2 (en) | 2016-11-02 | 2019-12-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beam refinement reference signal enhancement for higher mobility support |
US10893523B2 (en) | 2016-11-02 | 2021-01-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Wireless communication between wideband ENB and narrowband UE |
US10455455B2 (en) | 2016-11-04 | 2019-10-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for reservation preamble for prioritized medium contention in a new radio shared spectrum communication system |
US10187900B2 (en) | 2016-11-04 | 2019-01-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference management with coloring concept |
US10609664B2 (en) | 2016-11-04 | 2020-03-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques and apparatuses for frequency division multiplexing (FDM) based medium access on shared spectrum |
US10715301B2 (en) | 2016-11-07 | 2020-07-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) in frequency-division duplexing (FDD) spectrum |
US10327241B2 (en) | 2016-11-07 | 2019-06-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Solving deafness in directional clear channel assessment (CCA) |
US10581568B2 (en) | 2016-11-11 | 2020-03-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Network discovery and synchronization for NR-SS |
US10548020B2 (en) | 2016-11-14 | 2020-01-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for selectively adjusting wireless communication parameters based on aggregated interference from listen-before-talk wireless devices |
US10645590B2 (en) | 2016-11-16 | 2020-05-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Self-contained transmissions for machine type communications |
US10362574B2 (en) | 2016-11-18 | 2019-07-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink resource allocation techniques for shared radio frequency spectrum |
US10638444B2 (en) | 2016-12-01 | 2020-04-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Positioning techniques for wireless communications devices using shared radio frequency spectrum |
US10674389B2 (en) | 2016-12-01 | 2020-06-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Access terminal radio link monitoring (RLM) on a shared communication medium |
US10541771B2 (en) | 2016-12-02 | 2020-01-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for transmitting or using a pull-in signal to locate a synchronization channel |
US10356626B2 (en) | 2016-12-06 | 2019-07-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Opportunistic reclaiming of resources in new radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) |
US10820316B2 (en) | 2016-12-08 | 2020-10-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coordinated slotted medium access for shared spectrum new radio |
US10856185B2 (en) | 2016-12-09 | 2020-12-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation signals for new radio interference management |
US10536966B2 (en) | 2016-12-09 | 2020-01-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Physical downlink control channel and hybrid automatic repeat request feedback for multefire coverage enhancement |
US10779320B2 (en) | 2016-12-16 | 2020-09-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation signal with new radio PDCCH waveform |
US10581572B2 (en) | 2016-12-16 | 2020-03-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Autonomous uplink transmissions on a shared communication medium |
US10425826B2 (en) | 2016-12-21 | 2019-09-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Autonomous uplink (UL)/downlink (DL) transmission in new radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) |
US10231131B2 (en) | 2017-01-13 | 2019-03-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Autonomous uplink (UL) transmission in new radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) |
US10470048B2 (en) | 2017-01-17 | 2019-11-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic time-division duplexing (TDD) in new radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) and self-contained subframe structure |
US10638431B2 (en) | 2017-01-20 | 2020-04-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Power control for coordinated multipoint joint transmission |
US10327261B2 (en) | 2017-01-26 | 2019-06-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Directional listen before talk scheme |
US11096181B2 (en) | 2017-01-30 | 2021-08-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Monitoring interference level to selectively control usage of a contention-based protocol |
US11310695B2 (en) | 2017-02-03 | 2022-04-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-subframe discovery reference signaling (DRS) measurement timing configuration (DMTC) window |
US10659102B2 (en) | 2017-02-04 | 2020-05-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization techniques using frequency hopping in unlicensed radio frequency spectrum |
US11057926B2 (en) | 2017-02-04 | 2021-07-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Physical uplink shared channel coverage enhancements |
US10772113B2 (en) | 2017-02-06 | 2020-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Autonomous uplink transmission techniques using shared radio frequency spectrum |
US11032718B2 (en) | 2017-02-06 | 2021-06-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Optimizing millimeter wave beam searching |
US10231132B2 (en) | 2017-02-10 | 2019-03-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reservation signal design for spectrum sharing |
CN110291744B (en) | 2017-02-16 | 2022-05-24 | 高通股份有限公司 | Method for determining DMRS average delay and delay spread under smooth precoding |
US10333595B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2019-06-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reference signal and Tx/Rx precoding for UE multiplexing in NR SS |
US10404434B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2019-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Discovery and random access for shared spectrum |
US10700802B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2020-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Variable length reference signaling for fast acquisition in shared spectrum |
US10667288B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2020-05-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for configuring or transmitting grantless transmissions on beams in uplink subframes |
US10368301B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2019-07-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-beam and single-beam discovery reference signals for shared spectrum |
US10405262B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2019-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for signaling a public land mobile network identifier over a shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US10225818B2 (en) | 2017-02-22 | 2019-03-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Paging user equipments on a shared communication medium |
US10681723B2 (en) | 2017-02-27 | 2020-06-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Technique for HARQ, multiplexing, and contention |
US10477437B2 (en) | 2017-02-27 | 2019-11-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Node-specific medium reservation for spectrum sharing |
US10405335B2 (en) | 2017-03-01 | 2019-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Soft channel reservation |
US10638517B2 (en) | 2017-03-06 | 2020-04-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation signal design for shared spectrum |
US10362612B2 (en) | 2017-03-06 | 2019-07-23 | Citrix Systems, Inc. | Virtual private networking based on peer-to-peer communication |
US10411795B2 (en) | 2017-03-14 | 2019-09-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coverage enhancement mode switching for wireless communications using shared radio frequency spectrum |
US10555203B2 (en) | 2017-03-22 | 2020-02-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation techniques for millimeter wave systems |
US10667244B2 (en) | 2017-03-23 | 2020-05-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques and apparatuses for waveform signaling for downlink communications |
US10484934B2 (en) | 2017-03-24 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Network discovery for wireless communications |
US10716013B2 (en) | 2017-03-24 | 2020-07-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beam refinement for millimeter wave (MMW) system |
US10925048B2 (en) | 2017-03-30 | 2021-02-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Control resource set for single-carrier waveform |
US11032808B2 (en) | 2017-03-30 | 2021-06-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frequency hopping for control resource set with single carrier waveform |
US10623163B2 (en) | 2017-03-31 | 2020-04-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coexistence of control resource sets with different waveforms |
US11469945B2 (en) | 2017-04-03 | 2022-10-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic bandwidth configuration in narrowband communication |
US11063800B2 (en) | 2017-04-04 | 2021-07-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization signaling supporting multiple waveforms |
US10548153B2 (en) | 2017-04-04 | 2020-01-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for supporting frequency division multiplexing of multiple waveforms |
US10484992B2 (en) | 2017-04-05 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation for multi-user scheduling |
US10511399B2 (en) | 2017-04-07 | 2019-12-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques and apparatuses for downlink control channel design using a top to bottom search space |
US10462676B2 (en) | 2017-04-10 | 2019-10-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Inter-operator SRS resource coordination in SDM-comp |
US10433179B2 (en) | 2017-04-12 | 2019-10-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Spatial-division multiple access (SDMA) across multiple operators |
US10547422B2 (en) | 2017-04-13 | 2020-01-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | SRS transmission with implied RTS/CTS |
US10897326B2 (en) | 2017-04-14 | 2021-01-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Sharing a single coreset bandwidth across multiple user equipments |
US10609660B2 (en) | 2017-04-19 | 2020-03-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization for wideband coverage enhancement |
US10484954B2 (en) | 2017-05-10 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization for wideband coverage enhancement |
US10298289B2 (en) | 2017-04-19 | 2019-05-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization and paging channel design for wireless communications |
US10721774B2 (en) | 2017-04-24 | 2020-07-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frequency hopping configuration for a multi-tone physical random access channel transmission |
US10575185B2 (en) | 2017-04-27 | 2020-02-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Spectrum renting negotiation |
US10595342B2 (en) | 2017-05-01 | 2020-03-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Simultaneous reception sweep and transmission in a full-duplex node |
US10764840B2 (en) | 2017-05-05 | 2020-09-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Sounding reference signal (SRS) coordination, power control, and synchronization for distributed coordinated multipoint (CoMP) |
US10404509B2 (en) | 2017-05-11 | 2019-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Slot structure design using guard intervals in a single carrier waveform |
US10455457B2 (en) | 2017-05-24 | 2019-10-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | NR-SS unified operation mode in coordinated and uncoordinated bands |
US10687359B2 (en) | 2017-05-25 | 2020-06-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | System acquisition in a shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US10541851B2 (en) | 2017-05-25 | 2020-01-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization signal block signaling for wireless communications in shared spectrum |
US10904908B2 (en) | 2017-06-01 | 2021-01-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Grantless uplink transmission for eMTC-U |
US10701644B2 (en) | 2017-06-06 | 2020-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced macro diversity in new radio (NR) |
US10405228B2 (en) | 2017-06-08 | 2019-09-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | System information block providing cell access information supporting wideband coverage enhancement in wireless communication networks |
US10484935B2 (en) | 2017-06-12 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Discovery for spectrum renting |
US11051263B2 (en) | 2017-06-15 | 2021-06-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronization channel and system acquisition for internet of things communications in a shared spectrum |
US10700910B2 (en) | 2017-06-16 | 2020-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Single carrier waveform data transmission and reception based on configurable DFT window |
US10575229B2 (en) | 2017-06-21 | 2020-02-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for multiplexing hybrid satellite constellations |
US10602543B2 (en) | 2017-06-23 | 2020-03-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Asynchronous channel reservation design with partial symbol alignment |
US10856296B2 (en) | 2017-06-28 | 2020-12-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques and apparatuses for determining channels for frequency hopping in an unlicensed radio frequency spectrum band |
US10574422B2 (en) | 2017-06-30 | 2020-02-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Rate control adaptation |
US10687219B2 (en) | 2017-07-05 | 2020-06-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink transmission techniques in shared spectrum wireless communications |
US10701717B2 (en) | 2017-07-05 | 2020-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coexistence of autonomous and grant based uplink transmissions |
US10638371B2 (en) | 2017-07-06 | 2020-04-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Universal reservation signal for medium sharing |
US11025403B2 (en) | 2017-07-12 | 2021-06-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frame structure dependent configuration of physical channels |
US10673676B2 (en) | 2017-07-12 | 2020-06-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques and apparatuses for multiplexing schemes for millimeter wave downlink single carrier waveforms |
US10700907B2 (en) | 2017-07-12 | 2020-06-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Waveform for millimeter wave new radio |
US10848251B2 (en) | 2017-07-14 | 2020-11-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel quality measurement in unlicensed deployments |
US11122566B2 (en) | 2017-07-20 | 2021-09-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Waveform design based on power spectral density (PSD) parameters |
US10694493B2 (en) | 2017-07-24 | 2020-06-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Paging and DRX enhancements for eMTC-U (IOT-U) |
US11064424B2 (en) | 2017-07-25 | 2021-07-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Shared spectrum synchronization design |
US11252645B2 (en) | 2017-07-28 | 2022-02-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | DMTC window reservation signal in NR shared spectrum |
US10959267B2 (en) | 2017-07-28 | 2021-03-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | RACH configurations for NR shared spectrum |
US10798602B2 (en) | 2017-07-31 | 2020-10-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio resource management and radio link monitoring for enhanced machine type communication in shared spectrum |
US10484959B2 (en) | 2017-07-31 | 2019-11-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Positioning techniques in wireless communication systems |
US10616737B2 (en) | 2017-07-31 | 2020-04-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced machine type communications physical uplink control channel design |
US10687356B2 (en) | 2017-08-08 | 2020-06-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel reservation signal in NR shared spectrum |
US10917918B2 (en) | 2017-08-15 | 2021-02-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | EMTC-U-UCI reporting procedures and enhancements |
US11051175B2 (en) | 2017-08-18 | 2021-06-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink transmission techniques in shared spectrum wireless communications |
US10772125B2 (en) | 2017-08-28 | 2020-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Systems and methods for a spatial listen-before-talk protocol |
US10813136B2 (en) | 2017-08-30 | 2020-10-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dual connectivity with a network that utilizes an unlicensed frequency spectrum |
US20190075597A1 (en) | 2017-09-01 | 2019-03-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods, apparatuses and systems for supporting long term channel sensing in shared spectrum |
US10985897B2 (en) | 2017-09-11 | 2021-04-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for dynamic time-division duplexing (TDD) |
US10904773B2 (en) | 2017-09-12 | 2021-01-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beam management techniques in millimeter wave systems |
US10986665B2 (en) | 2017-09-15 | 2021-04-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Quasi-colocation for LBT |
US11012922B2 (en) | 2017-09-18 | 2021-05-18 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Common search space design for coverage enhancement in wireless communications |
US10523300B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2019-12-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beam refinement techniques in millimeter wave systems |
US10652914B2 (en) | 2017-09-20 | 2020-05-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | CSI-RS scrambling of subframes in a multi-subframe DRS |
US10511987B2 (en) | 2017-09-20 | 2019-12-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus related to enhanced machine type communication |
US11683833B2 (en) | 2017-09-28 | 2023-06-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Spatial listen-before-talk (LBT) with channel variation consideration |
US11019605B2 (en) | 2017-09-29 | 2021-05-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reservation repetition for deafness avoidance |
US11064518B2 (en) | 2017-09-29 | 2021-07-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Asynchronous single beam directional listen-before-talk |
US10925090B2 (en) | 2017-09-29 | 2021-02-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | On-demand listen-before-talk |
US10959105B2 (en) | 2017-09-29 | 2021-03-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods, apparatuses and systems for configuring bandwidth parts in shared spectrum |
US11102815B2 (en) | 2017-10-02 | 2021-08-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Asynchronous spatial LBT |
US11064439B2 (en) | 2017-10-09 | 2021-07-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Asynchronous carrier aggregation |
US10841805B2 (en) | 2017-10-10 | 2020-11-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Inter-operator coordination for channel access in shared spectrum |
US10728928B2 (en) | 2017-10-11 | 2020-07-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Random backoff process for spatial listen-before-talk (LBT) |
US10932282B2 (en) | 2017-10-11 | 2021-02-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Scheduling timeline in new radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) |
US10674498B2 (en) | 2017-10-12 | 2020-06-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Accelerated cell activation in wireless communication |
US10856300B2 (en) | 2017-10-17 | 2020-12-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Per-TTI rank control within transmission opportunity for downlink comp |
US10736112B2 (en) | 2017-10-19 | 2020-08-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Common search space scrambling for MulteFire coverage enhancement |
US10631261B2 (en) | 2017-10-19 | 2020-04-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Legacy compatible primary synchronization signal / secondary synchronization signal design for coverage extended and cost-reduced user equipment |
US11115924B2 (en) | 2017-10-19 | 2021-09-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for transmission and detection of multi-band wake-up |
US10945288B2 (en) | 2017-10-23 | 2021-03-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reservation and challenge schemes for listen-before-talk |
US10652854B2 (en) | 2017-10-30 | 2020-05-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Paging super frame window for narrowband communications using the unlicensed spectrum |
US11678333B2 (en) | 2017-11-03 | 2023-06-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for bandwidth part enhancement |
US10959263B2 (en) | 2017-11-03 | 2021-03-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Listen before talk for millimeter wave multi-user multiple-input multiple-output communications |
US11006415B2 (en) | 2017-11-07 | 2021-05-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel list signaling |
US10772110B2 (en) | 2017-11-07 | 2020-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Universal channel reservation signal for medium sharing |
US10834782B2 (en) | 2017-11-07 | 2020-11-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for low-band anchored high-band connections in wireless communications |
US11324047B2 (en) | 2017-11-10 | 2022-05-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | NR-unlicensed transmission opportunity structure with flexible starting point |
US10674449B2 (en) | 2017-11-13 | 2020-06-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Signal for a synchronized communication system operating in a shared spectrum frequency band |
US10879954B2 (en) | 2017-11-14 | 2020-12-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Logical channel hopping sequence design |
US10965514B2 (en) | 2017-11-17 | 2021-03-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Training field assisted medium sensing across multiple radio access technologies |
US10805979B2 (en) | 2017-11-21 | 2020-10-13 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dual band discontinuous reception |
US10764920B2 (en) | 2017-11-27 | 2020-09-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Semi-persistent scheduling for shared spectrum downlink |
US10863543B2 (en) | 2017-12-01 | 2020-12-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Subband based uplink access for NR-SS |
US10707915B2 (en) | 2017-12-04 | 2020-07-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Narrowband frequency hopping mechanisms to overcome bandwidth restrictions in the unlicensed frequency spectrum |
US11863315B2 (en) | 2017-12-04 | 2024-01-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques and apparatuses for avoiding collisions on an uplink data channel and a cell-specific or UE-specific uplink control channel |
US10784999B2 (en) | 2017-12-08 | 2020-09-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Narrowband physical broadcast channel design on multiple anchor channels |
US11102763B2 (en) | 2017-12-08 | 2021-08-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Techniques for multiplexing of uplink channels in a shared radio frequency spectrum band |
US11388728B2 (en) | 2017-12-08 | 2022-07-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel availability protocol in a shared spectrum |
US11552750B2 (en) | 2017-12-15 | 2023-01-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Subband-based random access and scheduling request for new-radio-spectrum sharing (NR-SS) |
US10708950B2 (en) | 2018-01-16 | 2020-07-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission opportunity sharing for autonomous uplink |
US11038567B2 (en) | 2018-01-23 | 2021-06-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Adaptive autonomous uplink communication design |
US10862581B2 (en) | 2018-01-30 | 2020-12-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Dynamic time division duplex (TDD) frame structure for hopping superframes |
US11025296B2 (en) | 2018-01-30 | 2021-06-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Nested frequency hopping for data transmission |
US10992427B2 (en) | 2018-01-31 | 2021-04-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Bandwidth reservation signal for base station operation in digital modulation |
US10939441B2 (en) | 2018-01-31 | 2021-03-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Autonomous uplink with analog beams |
US10772132B2 (en) | 2018-02-08 | 2020-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | PRACH configuration on NR-U |
US10912129B2 (en) | 2018-02-08 | 2021-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | SSB multiplexing and RMSI monitoring in NR-U |
US10965424B2 (en) | 2018-02-09 | 2021-03-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Uplink control information transmission in autonomous uplink |
US11102765B2 (en) | 2018-02-22 | 2021-08-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced uplink grant-free/downlink semi-persistent scheduling for ultra-reliable low latency communications |
US10897764B2 (en) | 2018-02-23 | 2021-01-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio-unlicensed (NR-U) interlace-based resource allocations |
US11071138B2 (en) | 2018-02-23 | 2021-07-20 | Qualcomm Incorporated | OTA dynamic TDD with CUI-R multiplexed in UL |
US11363630B2 (en) | 2018-03-01 | 2022-06-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Bandwidth part (BWP) configuration for subband access in new radio-unlicensed (NR-U) |
US11212051B2 (en) | 2018-03-06 | 2021-12-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beam management for autonomous uplink with analog beams |
US11470655B2 (en) | 2018-03-27 | 2022-10-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Enhanced downlink control information detection |
US11246155B2 (en) | 2018-03-27 | 2022-02-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Acknowledgement feedback in unlicensed new radio |
US10972217B2 (en) | 2018-03-30 | 2021-04-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Scheduling for low-density parity-check codes |
US10863524B2 (en) | 2018-04-04 | 2020-12-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multiplexing rules for mixed communication protocols |
US11019504B2 (en) | 2018-04-04 | 2021-05-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | On-demand coverage extended broadcast signal |
US10965505B2 (en) | 2018-04-05 | 2021-03-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Flexible waveform synthesis in NR-SS |
US10742353B2 (en) | 2018-04-09 | 2020-08-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Cross-correlation reduction for control signals |
US11089575B2 (en) | 2018-04-11 | 2021-08-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-carrier enhancements for improving reliability in URLLC-U |
US11082187B2 (en) | 2018-04-12 | 2021-08-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Rate-matching for single downlink control information multi-transmission reception point transmissions |
US10917905B2 (en) | 2018-04-16 | 2021-02-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Autonomous uplink transmission using shared radio frequency spectrum |
US11026218B2 (en) | 2018-04-16 | 2021-06-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Indication on joint multi-transmission point transmission in new radio system |
US11233614B2 (en) | 2018-04-18 | 2022-01-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Discovery reference signals in narrowband communications |
US11057885B2 (en) | 2018-04-26 | 2021-07-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frame-based initiator device operation |
US11259327B2 (en) | 2018-04-27 | 2022-02-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Listen-before-talk operation in an unlicensed downlink and licensed uplink deployment |
US11190234B2 (en) | 2018-04-27 | 2021-11-30 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Opportunistic frequency switching for frame based equipment |
US11050531B2 (en) | 2018-04-27 | 2021-06-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Frequency diversity with carrier hopping in unlicensed spectrum |
US11265917B2 (en) | 2018-04-30 | 2022-03-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Aligned LBT gaps for single operator FBE NR-SS |
US10848978B2 (en) | 2018-04-30 | 2020-11-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio (NR) for spectrum sharing |
US11115161B2 (en) | 2018-05-02 | 2021-09-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission diversity for FBE idle period handling |
US11177909B2 (en) | 2018-05-04 | 2021-11-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus related to ACK/NACK feedback with multi-TRP transmissions |
US11272526B2 (en) | 2018-05-09 | 2022-03-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Efficient operation with unlicensed downlink (DL) and licensed uplink (UL) by transmission of selective DL messages using licensed UL |
US11582000B2 (en) | 2018-05-11 | 2023-02-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Front loaded sounding reference signal and physical random access channel signal |
US11129196B2 (en) | 2018-05-11 | 2021-09-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Shared channel design around reserved resources |
US10841953B2 (en) | 2018-05-21 | 2020-11-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Receiver-based listen before talk techniques in shared millimeter wave radio frequency spectrum |
US10841950B2 (en) | 2018-05-21 | 2020-11-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Listen before talk techniques in shared millimeter wave radio frequency spectrum |
US11109285B2 (en) | 2018-05-24 | 2021-08-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-PCell design for URLLC reliability |
US10855355B2 (en) | 2018-05-25 | 2020-12-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Channel state information reporting enhancements for unlicensed coordinated multipoint |
US10728913B2 (en) | 2018-05-25 | 2020-07-28 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-transmission/reception point (multi-TRP) transmission with dynamic TRP clusters |
US11503559B2 (en) | 2018-05-29 | 2022-11-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Cell acquisition in frequency diversity implementing opportunistic frequency switching for frame based equipment access |
US10785797B2 (en) | 2018-06-04 | 2020-09-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Beam refinement reference signal (BRRS) design for mmWave system in shared spectrum |
US11770851B2 (en) | 2018-06-06 | 2023-09-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronized spectrum sharing across multiple adjacent carriers |
US11108598B2 (en) | 2018-06-11 | 2021-08-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission preemption in multi-TRP operation |
US20190387532A1 (en) | 2018-06-18 | 2019-12-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | System information block transmission scheduling |
US11122592B2 (en) | 2018-06-20 | 2021-09-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | 5G new radio with sharing between priority access license and general authorized access communications |
US10952103B2 (en) | 2018-06-27 | 2021-03-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission opportunity (TXOP) structure for new radio-unlicensed (NR-U) and new radio-synchronized sharing (NR-SS) |
US10912012B2 (en) | 2018-06-29 | 2021-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Initial network access for downlink unlicensed deployment |
US10631333B2 (en) | 2018-07-06 | 2020-04-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronized medium sharing with private network |
US10873440B2 (en) | 2018-07-12 | 2020-12-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Time division duplexing techniques in shared radio frequency spectrum |
US11184777B2 (en) | 2018-07-19 | 2021-11-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Synchronous shared spectrum |
US11324016B2 (en) | 2018-07-25 | 2022-05-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Multi-operator shared spectrum structure compatible with frame-based equipment |
US11026097B2 (en) | 2018-08-03 | 2021-06-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coexistence between spectrum sharing systems and asynchronous channel access systems |
US10841957B2 (en) | 2018-08-03 | 2020-11-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Facilitating multi-node listen before talk functionality via a centralized controller |
US10721628B2 (en) | 2018-08-09 | 2020-07-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Low-latency communication in shared spectrum |
US11089518B2 (en) | 2018-08-10 | 2021-08-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Intertechnology medium sharing for millimeter wave |
US11223505B2 (en) | 2018-08-22 | 2022-01-11 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Waveform multiplexing in millimeter wave band |
US11095396B2 (en) | 2018-08-23 | 2021-08-17 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Efficient polar detection with dynamic control and optimization |
US11153781B2 (en) | 2018-08-24 | 2021-10-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Variable cyclic prefix (CP) within a transmission slot in millimeter wave band |
US11696284B2 (en) | 2018-09-10 | 2023-07-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Interference detection, signaling, and mitigation techniques for low latency transmissions |
US11363465B2 (en) | 2018-09-26 | 2022-06-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Licensed supplemental uplink as fallback with unlicensed uplink and downlink |
US10880889B2 (en) | 2018-09-26 | 2020-12-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Narrowband user equipment (UE) support with multi-channel listen-before-talk (LBT) |
US11172504B2 (en) | 2018-09-27 | 2021-11-09 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coordination of listen before talk structure in new radio-unlicensed multi-channel access |
US11751242B2 (en) | 2018-09-27 | 2023-09-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Radio-unlicensed multi-channel access for low-radio frequency-capable user equipment |
US11265887B2 (en) | 2018-09-28 | 2022-03-01 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Measurement report on user equipment clear channel assessment status |
US20210243226A1 (en) | 2020-02-03 | 2021-08-05 | Purdue Research Foundation | Lifelong learning based intelligent, diverse, agile, and robust system for network attack detection |
-
2021
- 2021-04-14 CN CN202180028541.3A patent/CN115428513A/en active Pending
- 2021-04-14 EP EP21788909.6A patent/EP4136873A4/en active Pending
- 2021-04-14 US US17/230,783 patent/US12088499B2/en active Active
- 2021-04-14 US US17/230,805 patent/US12068953B2/en active Active
- 2021-04-14 CA CA3175361A patent/CA3175361A1/en active Pending
- 2021-04-14 AU AU2021256985A patent/AU2021256985A1/en active Pending
- 2021-04-14 KR KR1020227039691A patent/KR20230008750A/en active Search and Examination
- 2021-04-14 WO PCT/US2021/027268 patent/WO2021211702A1/en active Application Filing
- 2021-04-15 TW TW110113645A patent/TW202145736A/en unknown
-
2024
- 2024-06-28 US US18/759,545 patent/US20240356848A1/en active Pending
Patent Citations (46)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20070230357A1 (en) * | 2006-03-31 | 2007-10-04 | Nortel Networks Limited | Loop detection in a communications network |
US20090016250A1 (en) * | 2007-07-10 | 2009-01-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Coding methods of communicating identifiers in peer discovery in a peer-to-peer network |
US20090116420A1 (en) * | 2007-11-02 | 2009-05-07 | Docomo Communications Laboratories Usa, Inc. | Synchronized multi-link transmission in an arq-enabled multi-hop wireless network |
US20110202610A1 (en) * | 2010-02-15 | 2011-08-18 | Damaka, Inc. | System and method for signaling and data tunneling in a peer-to-peer environment |
US20130294461A1 (en) * | 2010-11-13 | 2013-11-07 | Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. | CGN Entity Based Data Transmission Method, CGN Entity, Gateway, and System |
US20120320932A1 (en) * | 2011-06-20 | 2012-12-20 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Data frame for plc having destination address in the phy header |
US8693344B1 (en) * | 2011-09-27 | 2014-04-08 | Big Switch Network, Inc. | Systems and methods for generating packet forwarding rules based on network policy |
US20130301611A1 (en) * | 2012-05-10 | 2013-11-14 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and system for connectionless transmission during uplink and downlink of data packets |
US20140126580A1 (en) * | 2012-11-02 | 2014-05-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method, device, and apparatus for error detection and correction in wireless communications |
US20140280969A1 (en) * | 2013-03-15 | 2014-09-18 | Conrad N. Wood | Load Balancer and Related Techniques |
US20150071171A1 (en) * | 2013-08-26 | 2015-03-12 | Nec Corporation | Communication device and method in a communication system, and device and method for communication path control |
US20160212678A1 (en) * | 2013-08-26 | 2016-07-21 | Nec Corporation | Communication apparatus and method, communication path control apparatus and method in a communication system |
US20160269355A1 (en) * | 2013-10-14 | 2016-09-15 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and device for setting selective source ip address |
US20160277929A1 (en) * | 2013-10-25 | 2016-09-22 | Hangzhou H3C Technologies Co., Ltd. | Network access control |
US9237546B1 (en) * | 2013-10-30 | 2016-01-12 | Marvell International Ltd. | Method and apparatus for determining a location of a network device in a wireless network |
US20160248542A1 (en) * | 2013-11-06 | 2016-08-25 | Mediatek Singapore Pte. Ltd. | Reception Failure Feedback Scheme in Wireless Local Area Networks |
US20160087779A1 (en) * | 2014-04-08 | 2016-03-24 | Empire Technology Development Llc | Full duplex radio communication |
US20160014714A1 (en) * | 2014-07-09 | 2016-01-14 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Traffic advertisement and scheduling in a neighbor aware network data link |
US20160277961A1 (en) * | 2014-09-12 | 2016-09-22 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Methods and systems for controlling congestion in a communication network |
US20170273080A1 (en) * | 2014-09-24 | 2017-09-21 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for communication between devices in wireless communication system |
US20160156392A1 (en) * | 2014-12-01 | 2016-06-02 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for communicating data between station and neighbor access point in communication system |
US20160344766A1 (en) * | 2015-05-19 | 2016-11-24 | Ford Global Technologies, Llc | Spoofing detection |
US20170034847A1 (en) * | 2015-07-31 | 2017-02-02 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for multi-channel medium access control protocol |
US20180234163A1 (en) * | 2015-08-13 | 2018-08-16 | Ntt Docomo, Inc. | Relay device and relay method |
US10015087B1 (en) * | 2015-12-17 | 2018-07-03 | Rockwell Collins, Inc. | Modem hardware abstraction layer (MHAL) on-chip bus packet router |
US20170180025A1 (en) * | 2015-12-21 | 2017-06-22 | Laurent Cariou | Techniques for passive beamforming training |
US20190052327A1 (en) * | 2016-04-15 | 2019-02-14 | Panasonic Intellectual Property Corporation Of America | Communication apparatus and communication method |
US20180004528A1 (en) * | 2016-06-30 | 2018-01-04 | Fujitsu Limited | Arithmetic processing device and control method of arithmetic processing device |
US20190350025A1 (en) * | 2016-09-30 | 2019-11-14 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Network Assistance via a Local Breakout Function-Gateway in RAN |
US20180145919A1 (en) * | 2016-11-23 | 2018-05-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Wi-fi link aggregation |
US20190349926A1 (en) * | 2017-02-01 | 2019-11-14 | Nokia Technologies Oy | Determining access slot for communications on radio interface |
US20180278624A1 (en) * | 2017-03-27 | 2018-09-27 | Zenedge, Inc. | Protection Configuration for Application Programming Interfaces |
US20180338265A1 (en) * | 2017-05-16 | 2018-11-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Ethernet over cellular |
US20200367170A1 (en) * | 2017-12-14 | 2020-11-19 | Panasonic Intellectual Property Corporation Of America | Communication apparatus and communication method |
US20210076329A1 (en) * | 2017-12-22 | 2021-03-11 | Nokia Technologies Oy | Distance aware wake-up radio operation |
US20200344684A1 (en) * | 2018-01-15 | 2020-10-29 | Nokia Technologies Oy | Power saving for wireless device |
US20210167907A1 (en) * | 2018-11-28 | 2021-06-03 | Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. | Interference Source Identification Method, Related Device, and Computer Storage Medium |
US20200275425A1 (en) * | 2019-02-22 | 2020-08-27 | Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. | Method and apparatus for sidelink transmission and resource allocation |
US11070467B1 (en) * | 2019-05-24 | 2021-07-20 | Amazon Technologies, Inc. | Expedited route recovery and load balancing in a multi-radio mesh network |
US20200383156A1 (en) * | 2019-06-03 | 2020-12-03 | Mediatek Singapore Pte. Ltd. | Systems and methods for constrained multi-link operation in a wireless network |
US20210127296A1 (en) * | 2019-10-25 | 2021-04-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Reducing feedback latency for network coding in wireless backhaul communications networks |
US20220107677A1 (en) * | 2019-11-01 | 2022-04-07 | Tencent Technology (Shenzhen) Company Limited | Data receiving and transmitting method and apparatus, computer device, and storage medium |
US20210321485A1 (en) * | 2020-04-09 | 2021-10-14 | Realtek Semiconductor Corp. | Mesh network system |
US20210328920A1 (en) * | 2020-04-15 | 2021-10-21 | XCOM Labs, Inc. | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity |
US20210352663A1 (en) * | 2020-05-08 | 2021-11-11 | Charter Communications Operating, Llc | Methods and apparatus for supporting prioritized transmission opportunity (txop) sharing |
US20210376973A1 (en) * | 2020-05-26 | 2021-12-02 | XCOM Labs, Inc. | Interference-aware beamforming |
Cited By (9)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20230284316A1 (en) * | 2017-12-15 | 2023-09-07 | Google Llc | Establishing and Terminating Wireless Links |
US12052789B2 (en) * | 2017-12-15 | 2024-07-30 | Google Llc | Establishing and terminating wireless links |
US12068953B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-08-20 | Virewirx, Inc. | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity |
US12088499B2 (en) | 2020-04-15 | 2024-09-10 | Virewirx, Inc. | System and method for reducing data packet processing false alarms |
US11515973B2 (en) | 2020-05-26 | 2022-11-29 | XCOM Labs, Inc. | Interference-aware beamforming |
US12081468B2 (en) | 2020-05-26 | 2024-09-03 | Virewirx, Inc. | Interference-aware beamforming |
US11395135B2 (en) * | 2020-12-04 | 2022-07-19 | Ultralogic 6G, Llc | Rapid multi-hop message transfer in 5G and 6G |
US20220353674A1 (en) * | 2020-12-04 | 2022-11-03 | David E. Newman | Just-in-Time Transmission of Data Messages in 5G and 6G |
US11956858B2 (en) * | 2020-12-04 | 2024-04-09 | David E. Newman | Just-in-time transmission of data messages in 5G and 6G |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
CN115428513A (en) | 2022-12-02 |
WO2021211702A1 (en) | 2021-10-21 |
EP4136873A1 (en) | 2023-02-22 |
US12068953B2 (en) | 2024-08-20 |
US20210328920A1 (en) | 2021-10-21 |
AU2021256985A1 (en) | 2022-11-10 |
TW202145736A (en) | 2021-12-01 |
EP4136873A4 (en) | 2024-07-10 |
US12088499B2 (en) | 2024-09-10 |
KR20230008750A (en) | 2023-01-16 |
US20240356848A1 (en) | 2024-10-24 |
CA3175361A1 (en) | 2021-10-21 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US12068953B2 (en) | Wireless network multipoint association and diversity | |
US10756860B2 (en) | Distributed multiple-input multiple-output downlink configuration | |
US11711118B2 (en) | Methods and systems for determining downlink data mode | |
US10432272B1 (en) | Variable multiple-input multiple-output downlink user equipment | |
US12081468B2 (en) | Interference-aware beamforming | |
AU2019375404B2 (en) | Cooperative multiple-input multiple-output downlink scheduling | |
US20190159220A1 (en) | Methods and systems for uplink mu-mimo scheduling | |
US20200195322A1 (en) | User equipment with cellular link and peer-to-peer link | |
US10812216B2 (en) | Cooperative multiple-input multiple-output downlink scheduling | |
US20200195313A1 (en) | Unbalanced wireless communication with group of devices | |
KR20210087089A (en) | Non-coherent cooperative multiple input/output communication | |
US11228355B2 (en) | Methods of energy optimization for multi-antenna systems | |
US20230319625A1 (en) | Replication in a Wireless Communication Network | |
US20240032019A1 (en) | Collision reduction in wireless medium access | |
US20240155360A1 (en) | Communication device | |
WO2022163266A1 (en) | Communication device and communication method |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
FEPP | Fee payment procedure |
Free format text: ENTITY STATUS SET TO UNDISCOUNTED (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: BIG.); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: SMALL ENTITY |
|
FEPP | Fee payment procedure |
Free format text: ENTITY STATUS SET TO SMALL (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: SMAL); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: SMALL ENTITY |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: XCOM LABS, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:KADOUS, TAMER ADEL;MALLIK, SIDDHARTHA;ELGHARIANI, ALI A.;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20210809 TO 20210818;REEL/FRAME:061247/0722 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: PAUL ERIC JACOBS TRUST, DTD APRIL 9, 2018, CALIFORNIA Free format text: SECURITY INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:XCOM LABS, INC.;REEL/FRAME:064165/0054 Effective date: 20230629 |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: XCOM LABS, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: RELEASE OF PATENT SECURITY AGREEMENT RECORDED AT REEL 064165/FRAME 0054;ASSIGNOR:PAUL ERIC JACOBS TRUST, DTD APRIL 9, 2018;REEL/FRAME:064807/0677 Effective date: 20230829 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: VIREWIRX, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: CHANGE OF NAME;ASSIGNOR:XCOM LABS, INC.;REEL/FRAME:065740/0871 Effective date: 20230929 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NOTICE OF ALLOWANCE MAILED -- APPLICATION RECEIVED IN OFFICE OF PUBLICATIONS |
|
ZAAA | Notice of allowance and fees due |
Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: NOA |
|
ZAAB | Notice of allowance mailed |
Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: MN/=. |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NOTICE OF ALLOWANCE MAILED -- APPLICATION RECEIVED IN OFFICE OF PUBLICATIONS |
|
ZAAA | Notice of allowance and fees due |
Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: NOA |
|
ZAAB | Notice of allowance mailed |
Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: MN/=. |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: PUBLICATIONS -- ISSUE FEE PAYMENT RECEIVED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: PUBLICATIONS -- ISSUE FEE PAYMENT VERIFIED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: AWAITING TC RESP, ISSUE FEE PAYMENT VERIFIED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: PUBLICATIONS -- ISSUE FEE PAYMENT VERIFIED |
|
STCF | Information on status: patent grant |
Free format text: PATENTED CASE |